Replace:
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518
KB
2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3@c 1999, 2000, 2001
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
e9c75b65 34@set DATE April 2001
c906108c 35
6d2ebf8b 36@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
c906108c 37
c906108c 38@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 39@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
40@dircategory Programming & development tools.
41@direntry
c906108c 42* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
43@end direntry
44
c906108c
SS
45@ifinfo
46This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
47
48
5d161b24 49This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
50of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
51for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
52
e9c75b65
EZ
53Copyright (C) 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
54 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 55
e9c75b65
EZ
56Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
57under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
58any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
59Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
60Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
61with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 62
e9c75b65
EZ
63(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
64this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
65Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
66@end ifinfo
67
68@titlepage
69@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
70@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 71@sp 1
c906108c
SS
72@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
73@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 74@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 75@page
c906108c
SS
76@tex
77{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 78\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
79\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
80\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
81}
82@end tex
53a5351d 83
c906108c 84@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
e9c75b65
EZ
85Copyright @copyright{} 1988,1989,1990,1991,1992,1993,1994,1995,1996,1998,1999,2000,2001
86 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 87@sp 2
c906108c
SS
88Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
8959 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
90Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 91ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
92
93Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
94under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
95any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
96Invariant Sections being ``A Sample GDB Session'' and ``Free
97Software'', with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and
98with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
99
100(a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
101this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
102Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
c906108c
SS
103@end titlepage
104@page
105
b9deaee7 106@ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
107@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
108
c906108c
SS
109@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
110
111This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
112
5d161b24 113This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
114@value{GDBVN}.
115
e9c75b65 116Copyright (C) 1988-2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
117
118@menu
119* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
120* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
121
122* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
123* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
124* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
125* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
126* Stack:: Examining the stack
127* Source:: Examining source files
128* Data:: Examining data
b37052ae 129* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
6d2ebf8b
SS
130
131* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
132
133* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
134* Altering:: Altering execution
135* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
136* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
137* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
138* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
139* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
140* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
141* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 142* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
143
144* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
145* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
146
147* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
148* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
149* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
150* Index:: Index
151@end menu
152
b9deaee7 153@end ifinfo
6d2ebf8b
SS
154
155@c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
156
157@ifhtml
158@node Top
159
160@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
161
162This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
163
b37052ae 164This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
6d2ebf8b
SS
165@value{GDBVN}.
166
167Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
168
c906108c
SS
169@menu
170* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
c906108c 171* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
c906108c
SS
172
173* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
174* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
175* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
176* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
177* Stack:: Examining the stack
178* Source:: Examining source files
179* Data:: Examining data
c906108c 180
7a292a7a 181* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
c906108c
SS
182
183* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
184* Altering:: Altering execution
185* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
186* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
104c1213 187* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
c906108c
SS
188* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
189* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c906108c 190* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
6d2ebf8b 191* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
c906108c
SS
192
193* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 194* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
c906108c
SS
195
196* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
197* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
198* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
199* Index:: Index
c906108c
SS
200@end menu
201
6d2ebf8b
SS
202@end ifhtml
203
449f3b6c
AC
204@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
205@iftex
206@contents
207@end iftex
208
6d2ebf8b 209@node Summary
c906108c
SS
210@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
211
212The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
213going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
214program was doing at the moment it crashed.
215
216@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
217these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
218
219@itemize @bullet
220@item
221Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
222
223@item
224Make your program stop on specified conditions.
225
226@item
227Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
228
229@item
230Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
231effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
232@end itemize
233
cce74817 234You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 235For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
236For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
237
cce74817
JM
238@cindex Chill
239@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 240Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 241see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 242
cce74817
JM
243@cindex Pascal
244Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
245nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
246entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
247syntax.
c906108c 248
c906108c
SS
249@cindex Fortran
250@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 251it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 252underscore.
c906108c 253
c906108c
SS
254@menu
255* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
256* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257@end menu
258
6d2ebf8b 259@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
260@unnumberedsec Free software
261
5d161b24 262@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
263General Public License
264(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273from anyone else.
274
6d2ebf8b 275@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
276@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
277
278Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
279other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
280development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
281of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
282to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
283file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
284blow-by-blow account.
285
286Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
287
288@quotation
289@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
290or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
291omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
292@end quotation
293
294So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
295particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
296releases:
b37052ae 297Andrew Cagney (releases 5.0 and 5.1);
c906108c
SS
298Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
299Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
300Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
301Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
302Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
303John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
304Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
305and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
306
307Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
308Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
309
b37052ae
EZ
310Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
311in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
312Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
313demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
314much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 315
b37052ae 316@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
317object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
318Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
319
320David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
321the original support for encapsulated COFF.
322
96c405b3 323Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
324
325Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
326Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
327support.
328Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
329Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
330Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
331David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
332Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
333Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
334Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
335Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
336Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
337Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
338Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
339Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
340Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
341Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
342Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
343
344Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
345
346Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
347libraries.
348
349Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
350about several machine instruction sets.
351
352Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
353remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
354contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
355and RDI targets, respectively.
356
357Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
358command-line editing and command history.
359
7a292a7a
SS
360Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
361Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 362
5d161b24 363Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 364He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 365symbols.
c906108c
SS
366
367Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
368Super-H processors.
369
370NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
371
372Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
373
374Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
375
376Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
377
96a2c332 378Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
379
380Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
381watchpoints.
382
383Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
384
385Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
386
387Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 388nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
389
390The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
391support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 392(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
393compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
394John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
395Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
396information in this manual.
397
b37052ae
EZ
398DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
399Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
400
96a2c332
SS
401Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
402development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
403fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
404Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
405Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
406Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
407Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
408addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
409JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
410Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
411Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
412Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
413Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
414Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
415Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
416
417
6d2ebf8b 418@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
419@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
420
421You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
422However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
423debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
424
425@iftex
426In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
427to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
428@end iftex
429
430@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
431@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
432
433One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
434processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
435quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
436definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
437session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
438then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
439same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
440@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
441procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
442
443@smallexample
444$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
445$ @b{./m4}
446@b{define(foo,0000)}
447
448@b{foo}
4490000
450@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
451
452@b{bar}
4530000
454@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
455
456@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
457@b{baz}
458@b{C-d}
459m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
460@end smallexample
461
462@noindent
463Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
464
c906108c
SS
465@smallexample
466$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
467@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
468@c FIXME... format to come out better.
469@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 470 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 471 the conditions.
5d161b24 472There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
473 for details.
474
475@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
476(@value{GDBP})
477@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
478
479@noindent
480@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
481rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
482We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
483that examples fit in this manual.
484
485@smallexample
486(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
487@end smallexample
488
489@noindent
490We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
491Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
492@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
493@code{break} command.
494
495@smallexample
496(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
497Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
498@end smallexample
499
500@noindent
501Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
502control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
503subroutine, the program runs as usual:
504
505@smallexample
506(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
507Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
508@b{define(foo,0000)}
509
510@b{foo}
5110000
512@end smallexample
513
514@noindent
515To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
516suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
517context where it stops.
518
519@smallexample
520@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
521
5d161b24 522Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
523 at builtin.c:879
524879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
525@end smallexample
526
527@noindent
528Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
529the next line of the current function.
530
531@smallexample
532(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
533882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
534 : nil,
535@end smallexample
536
537@noindent
538@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
539by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
540@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
541subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
542
543@smallexample
544(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
545set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
546 at input.c:530
547530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
548@end smallexample
549
550@noindent
551The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
552suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
553shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
554command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
555in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
556stack frame for each active subroutine.
557
558@smallexample
559(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
560#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
561 at input.c:530
5d161b24 562#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
563 at builtin.c:882
564#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
565#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
566 at macro.c:71
567#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
568#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
569@end smallexample
570
571@noindent
572We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
573times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
574falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
575
576@smallexample
577(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5780x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
579(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
5800x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
581def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
582(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
583536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
584 : xstrdup(rq);
585(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
586538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
587@end smallexample
588
589@noindent
590The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
591@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
592and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
593(@code{print}) to see their values.
594
595@smallexample
596(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
597$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
598(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
599$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
600@end smallexample
601
602@noindent
603@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
604To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
605surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
606
607@smallexample
608(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
609533 xfree(rquote);
610534
611535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
612 : xstrdup (lq);
613536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
614 : xstrdup (rq);
615537
616538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
617539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
618540 @}
619541
620542 void
621@end smallexample
622
623@noindent
624Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
625@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
626
627@smallexample
628(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
629539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
630(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631540 @}
632(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
633$3 = 9
634(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
635$4 = 7
636@end smallexample
637
638@noindent
639That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
640@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
641@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
642the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
643any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
644assignments.
645
646@smallexample
647(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
648$5 = 7
649(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
650$6 = 9
651@end smallexample
652
653@noindent
654Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
655@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
656executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
657example that caused trouble initially:
658
659@smallexample
660(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
661Continuing.
662
663@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
664
665baz
6660000
667@end smallexample
668
669@noindent
670Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
671problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
672lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
673
674@smallexample
675@b{C-d}
676Program exited normally.
677@end smallexample
678
679@noindent
680The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
681indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
682session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
683
684@smallexample
685(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
686@end smallexample
c906108c 687
6d2ebf8b 688@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
689@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
690
691This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 692The essentials are:
c906108c 693@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 694@item
53a5351d 695type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 696@item
c906108c
SS
697type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
698@end itemize
699
700@menu
701* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
702* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
703* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
704@end menu
705
6d2ebf8b 706@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
707@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
708
c906108c
SS
709Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
710@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
711
712You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
713to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
714
c906108c
SS
715The command-line options described here are designed
716to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 717options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
718
719The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
720specifying an executable program:
721
722@example
723@value{GDBP} @var{program}
724@end example
725
c906108c
SS
726@noindent
727You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
728specified:
729
730@example
731@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
732@end example
733
734You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
735to debug a running process:
736
737@example
738@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
739@end example
740
741@noindent
742would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
743named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
744
c906108c 745Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
746complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
747debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
748``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
749will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 750
96a2c332 751You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
752@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
753
754@smallexample
755@value{GDBP} -silent
756@end smallexample
757
758@noindent
759You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
760options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
761
762@noindent
763Type
764
765@example
766@value{GDBP} -help
767@end example
768
769@noindent
770to display all available options and briefly describe their use
771(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
772
773All options and command line arguments you give are processed
774in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
775@samp{-x} option is used.
776
777
778@menu
c906108c
SS
779* File Options:: Choosing files
780* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
781@end menu
782
6d2ebf8b 783@node File Options
c906108c
SS
784@subsection Choosing files
785
2df3850c 786When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
787specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
788the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
789@samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
790that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
791@samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
792that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
793the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
7a292a7a
SS
794
795If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
796such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
797argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
798
799Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
800following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
801them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
802(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
803than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
804
d700128c
EZ
805@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
806@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
807@c it.
808
c906108c
SS
809@table @code
810@item -symbols @var{file}
811@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
812@cindex @code{--symbols}
813@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
814Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
815
816@item -exec @var{file}
817@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
818@cindex @code{--exec}
819@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
820Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
821and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
822
823@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 824@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
825Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
826file.
827
c906108c
SS
828@item -core @var{file}
829@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
830@cindex @code{--core}
831@cindex @code{-c}
c906108c
SS
832Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
833
834@item -c @var{number}
835Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
836(unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
837case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
c906108c
SS
838
839@item -command @var{file}
840@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
841@cindex @code{--command}
842@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
843Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
844Files,, Command files}.
845
846@item -directory @var{directory}
847@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
848@cindex @code{--directory}
849@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
850Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
851
c906108c
SS
852@item -m
853@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
854@cindex @code{--mapped}
855@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
856@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
857supported on all systems.}@*
858If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 859system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
860to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
861program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 862called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
863Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
864and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
865the symbol table from the executable program.
866
867The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
868is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
869table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 870
c906108c
SS
871@item -r
872@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
873@cindex @code{--readnow}
874@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
875Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
876the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
877This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 878
c906108c
SS
879@end table
880
2df3850c 881You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 882order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
883information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
884on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
885but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
886
887@example
2df3850c 888gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 889@end example
c906108c 890
6d2ebf8b 891@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
892@subsection Choosing modes
893
894You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
895batch mode or quiet mode.
896
897@table @code
898@item -nx
899@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
900@cindex @code{--nx}
901@cindex @code{-n}
2df3850c
JM
902Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
903called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
904@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
905options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
906files}.
c906108c
SS
907
908@item -quiet
d700128c 909@itemx -silent
c906108c 910@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
911@cindex @code{--quiet}
912@cindex @code{--silent}
913@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
914``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
915messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
916
917@item -batch
d700128c 918@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
919Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
920command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
921initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
922nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
923in the command files.
924
2df3850c
JM
925Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
926example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
927make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
928
929@example
930Program exited normally.
931@end example
932
933@noindent
2df3850c
JM
934(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
935@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
936mode.
937
938@item -nowindows
939@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
940@cindex @code{--nowindows}
941@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 942``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 943(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
944interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
945
946@item -windows
947@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
948@cindex @code{--windows}
949@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
950If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
951used if possible.
c906108c
SS
952
953@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 954@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
955Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
956instead of the current directory.
957
c906108c
SS
958@item -fullname
959@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
960@cindex @code{--fullname}
961@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
962@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
963subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
964number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
965displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
966recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
967the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
968and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
969@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
970frame.
c906108c 971
d700128c
EZ
972@item -epoch
973@cindex @code{--epoch}
974The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
975@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
976routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
977separate window.
978
979@item -annotate @var{level}
980@cindex @code{--annotate}
981This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
982effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
983(@pxref{Annotations}).
984Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
985together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
986types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
987@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
988maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
989
990@item -async
991@cindex @code{--async}
992Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
993@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
994special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
995commands in parallel with the debugged process being
996run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
997MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
998suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
999control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1000(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1001operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1002yet.)
1003@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1004@c should be removed.
1005
1006When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1007uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1008@samp{-noasync} option.
1009
1010@item -noasync
1011@cindex @code{--noasync}
1012Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1013
2df3850c
JM
1014@item -baud @var{bps}
1015@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1016@cindex @code{--baud}
1017@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1018Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1019interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1020
1021@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1022@itemx -t @var{device}
1023@cindex @code{--tty}
1024@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1025Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1026@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1027
53a5351d
JM
1028@c resolve the situation of these eventually
1029@c @item -tui
d700128c 1030@c @cindex @code{--tui}
53a5351d
JM
1031@c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
1032@c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
1033@c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
1034@c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
1035@c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1036
1037@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1038@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1039@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1040@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1041@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1042@c systems.
1043
d700128c
EZ
1044@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1045@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1046Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1047program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1048communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end. For example,
1049@samp{--interpreter=mi} causes @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdbmi
7162c0ca 1050interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}).
d700128c
EZ
1051
1052@item -write
1053@cindex @code{--write}
1054Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1055is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1056(@pxref{Patching}).
1057
1058@item -statistics
1059@cindex @code{--statistics}
1060This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1061memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1062
1063@item -version
1064@cindex @code{--version}
1065This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1066no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1067
c906108c
SS
1068@end table
1069
6d2ebf8b 1070@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1071@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1072@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1073@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1074
1075@table @code
1076@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1077@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1078@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1079@itemx q
1080To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1081@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1082do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1083otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1084error code.
c906108c
SS
1085@end table
1086
1087@cindex interrupt
1088An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1089terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1090returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1091character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1092until a time when it is safe.
1093
c906108c
SS
1094If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1095device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1096(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1097
6d2ebf8b 1098@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1099@section Shell commands
1100
1101If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1102debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1103just use the @code{shell} command.
1104
1105@table @code
1106@kindex shell
1107@cindex shell escape
1108@item shell @var{command string}
1109Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1110If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1111shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1112(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1113@end table
1114
1115The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1116You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1117@value{GDBN}:
1118
1119@table @code
1120@kindex make
1121@cindex calling make
1122@item make @var{make-args}
1123Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1124arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1125@end table
1126
6d2ebf8b 1127@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1128@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1129
1130You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1131name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1132@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1133key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1134show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1135
1136@menu
1137* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1138* Completion:: Command completion
1139* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1140@end menu
1141
6d2ebf8b 1142@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1143@section Command syntax
1144
1145A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1146how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1147arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1148command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1149step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1150with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1151
1152@cindex abbreviation
1153@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1154unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1155documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1156abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1157equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1158names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1159arguments to the @code{help} command.
1160
1161@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1162@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1163A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1164repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1165will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1166repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1167repeat.
1168
1169The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1170@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1171exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1172
1173@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1174output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1175(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1176@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1177repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1178
41afff9a 1179@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1180@cindex comment
1181Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1182nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1183Files,,Command files}).
1184
6d2ebf8b 1185@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1186@section Command completion
1187
1188@cindex completion
1189@cindex word completion
1190@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1191only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1192are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1193commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1194
1195Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1196of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1197word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1198enter it). For example, if you type
1199
1200@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1201@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1202@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1203@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1204@example
1205(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1206@end example
1207
1208@noindent
1209@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1210the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1211
1212@example
1213(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1214@end example
1215
1216@noindent
1217You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1218breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1219@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1220were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1221might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1222to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1223
1224If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1225@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1226characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1227@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1228example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1229begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1230just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1231function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1232example:
1233
1234@example
1235(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1236@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1237make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1238make_abs_section make_function_type
1239make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1240make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1241make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1242(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1243@end example
1244
1245@noindent
1246After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1247partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1248command.
1249
1250If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1251can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1252means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1253key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1254one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1255
1256@cindex quotes in commands
1257@cindex completion of quoted strings
1258Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1259parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1260its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1261situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1262@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1263
c906108c 1264The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1265name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1266overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1267by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1268may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1269that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1270that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1271word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1272@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1273@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1274when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c
SS
1275
1276@example
96a2c332 1277(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1278bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1279(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1280@end example
1281
1282In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1283quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1284completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1285place:
1286
1287@example
1288(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1289@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1290(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1291@end example
1292
1293@noindent
1294In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1295you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1296completion on an overloaded symbol.
1297
d4f3574e 1298For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1299expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1300overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1301see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1302
1303
6d2ebf8b 1304@node Help
c906108c
SS
1305@section Getting help
1306@cindex online documentation
1307@kindex help
1308
5d161b24 1309You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1310using the command @code{help}.
1311
1312@table @code
41afff9a 1313@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1314@item help
1315@itemx h
1316You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1317display a short list of named classes of commands:
1318
1319@smallexample
1320(@value{GDBP}) help
1321List of classes of commands:
1322
2df3850c 1323aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1324breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1325data -- Examining data
c906108c 1326files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1327internals -- Maintenance commands
1328obscure -- Obscure features
1329running -- Running the program
1330stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1331status -- Status inquiries
1332support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1333tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1334 stopping the program
c906108c 1335user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1336
5d161b24 1337Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1338commands in that class.
5d161b24 1339Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1340documentation.
1341Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1342(@value{GDBP})
1343@end smallexample
96a2c332 1344@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1345
1346@item help @var{class}
1347Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1348list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1349help display for the class @code{status}:
1350
1351@smallexample
1352(@value{GDBP}) help status
1353Status inquiries.
1354
1355List of commands:
1356
1357@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1358@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1359info -- Generic command for showing things
1360 about the program being debugged
1361show -- Generic command for showing things
1362 about the debugger
c906108c 1363
5d161b24 1364Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1365documentation.
1366Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1367(@value{GDBP})
1368@end smallexample
1369
1370@item help @var{command}
1371With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1372short paragraph on how to use that command.
1373
6837a0a2
DB
1374@kindex apropos
1375@item apropos @var{args}
1376The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1377commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1378@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1379
1380@smallexample
1381apropos reload
1382@end smallexample
1383
b37052ae
EZ
1384@noindent
1385results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1386
1387@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1388@c @group
1389set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1390 multiple times in one run
1391show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1392 multiple times in one run
1393@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1394@end smallexample
1395
c906108c
SS
1396@kindex complete
1397@item complete @var{args}
1398The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1399for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1400command you want completed. For example:
1401
1402@smallexample
1403complete i
1404@end smallexample
1405
1406@noindent results in:
1407
1408@smallexample
1409@group
2df3850c
JM
1410if
1411ignore
c906108c
SS
1412info
1413inspect
c906108c
SS
1414@end group
1415@end smallexample
1416
1417@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1418@end table
1419
1420In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1421and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1422of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1423manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1424under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1425all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1426
1427@c @group
1428@table @code
1429@kindex info
41afff9a 1430@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1431@item info
1432This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1433program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1434with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1435registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1436You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1437@w{@code{help info}}.
1438
1439@kindex set
1440@item set
5d161b24 1441You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1442@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1443@code{set prompt $}.
1444
1445@kindex show
1446@item show
5d161b24 1447In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1448@value{GDBN} itself.
1449You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1450related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1451system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1452which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1453
1454@kindex info set
1455To display all the settable parameters and their current
1456values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1457@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1458@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1459@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1460@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1461@end table
1462@c @end group
1463
1464Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1465exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1466
1467@table @code
1468@kindex show version
1469@cindex version number
1470@item show version
1471Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1472information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1473@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1474version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1475commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1476system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1477variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1478The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1479@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1480
1481@kindex show copying
1482@item show copying
1483Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1484
1485@kindex show warranty
1486@item show warranty
2df3850c 1487Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1488if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1489
c906108c
SS
1490@end table
1491
6d2ebf8b 1492@node Running
c906108c
SS
1493@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1494
1495When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1496debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1497
1498You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1499of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1500your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1501kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1502
1503@menu
1504* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1505* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1506* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1507* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1508
1509* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1510* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1511* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1512* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1513
1514* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1515* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1516@end menu
1517
6d2ebf8b 1518@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1519@section Compiling for debugging
1520
1521In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1522debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1523is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1524variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1525and addresses in the executable code.
1526
1527To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1528the compiler.
1529
1530Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1531options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1532executables containing debugging information.
1533
53a5351d
JM
1534@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1535without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1536recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1537program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1538in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1539
1540@cindex optimized code, debugging
1541@cindex debugging optimized code
1542When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1543optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1544really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1545exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1546variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1547variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1548
1549Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1550@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1551doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1552please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1553
1554Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1555@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1556format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1557
1558@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1559@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1560@section Starting your program
1561@cindex starting
1562@cindex running
1563
1564@table @code
1565@kindex run
41afff9a 1566@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1567@item run
1568@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1569Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1570You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1571argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1572@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1573(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1574
1575@end table
1576
c906108c
SS
1577If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1578supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1579that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1580@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1581
1582The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1583receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1584information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1585can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1586your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1587divided into four categories:
1588
1589@table @asis
1590@item The @emph{arguments.}
1591Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1592@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1593is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1594(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1595the arguments.
1596In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1597@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1598@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1599
1600@item The @emph{environment.}
1601Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1602use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1603environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1604your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1605
1606@item The @emph{working directory.}
1607Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1608the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1609@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1610
1611@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1612Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1613standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1614in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1615set a different device for your program.
1616@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1617
1618@cindex pipes
1619@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1620pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1621program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1622wrong program.
1623@end table
c906108c
SS
1624
1625When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1626immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1627of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1628stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1629or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1630
1631If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1632time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1633table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1634your current breakpoints.
1635
6d2ebf8b 1636@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1637@section Your program's arguments
1638
1639@cindex arguments (to your program)
1640The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1641@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1642They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1643performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1644@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1645@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1646the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1647
1648On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1649@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1650calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1651the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1652
1653@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1654@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1655
c906108c 1656@table @code
41afff9a 1657@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1658@item set args
1659Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1660@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1661with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1662using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1663it again without arguments.
1664
1665@kindex show args
1666@item show args
1667Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1668@end table
1669
6d2ebf8b 1670@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1671@section Your program's environment
1672
1673@cindex environment (of your program)
1674The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1675their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1676your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1677path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1678the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1679debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1680environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1681
1682@table @code
1683@kindex path
1684@item path @var{directory}
1685Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1686(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1687The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1688You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1689system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1690MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1691is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1692
1693You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1694working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1695use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1696@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1697@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1698@var{directory} to the search path.
1699@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1700@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1701
1702@kindex show paths
1703@item show paths
1704Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1705environment variable).
1706
1707@kindex show environment
1708@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1709Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1710your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1711print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1712your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1713
1714@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1715@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1716Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1717changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1718be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1719any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1720parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1721null value.
1722@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1723@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1724
1725For example, this command:
1726
1727@example
1728set env USER = foo
1729@end example
1730
1731@noindent
d4f3574e 1732tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1733@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1734are not actually required.)
1735
1736@kindex unset environment
1737@item unset environment @var{varname}
1738Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1739program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1740@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1741rather than assigning it an empty value.
1742@end table
1743
d4f3574e
SS
1744@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1745the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1746by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1747@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1748that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1749@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1750your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1751files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1752@file{.profile}.
1753
6d2ebf8b 1754@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1755@section Your program's working directory
1756
1757@cindex working directory (of your program)
1758Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1759working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1760The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1761from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1762working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1763
1764The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1765that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1766specify files}.
1767
1768@table @code
1769@kindex cd
1770@item cd @var{directory}
1771Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1772
1773@kindex pwd
1774@item pwd
1775Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1776@end table
1777
6d2ebf8b 1778@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1779@section Your program's input and output
1780
1781@cindex redirection
1782@cindex i/o
1783@cindex terminal
1784By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1785the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1786to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1787modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1788running your program.
1789
1790@table @code
1791@kindex info terminal
1792@item info terminal
1793Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1794program is using.
1795@end table
1796
1797You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1798redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1799
1800@example
1801run > outfile
1802@end example
1803
1804@noindent
1805starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1806
1807@kindex tty
1808@cindex controlling terminal
1809Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1810with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1811argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1812commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1813process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1814
1815@example
1816tty /dev/ttyb
1817@end example
1818
1819@noindent
1820directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1821default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1822that as their controlling terminal.
1823
1824An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1825effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1826terminal.
1827
1828When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1829command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1830for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1831
6d2ebf8b 1832@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1833@section Debugging an already-running process
1834@kindex attach
1835@cindex attach
1836
1837@table @code
1838@item attach @var{process-id}
1839This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1840outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1841targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1842find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1843or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1844
1845@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1846executing the command.
1847@end table
1848
1849To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1850which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1851programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1852also have permission to send the process a signal.
1853
1854When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1855the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1856the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1857(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1858the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1859Specify Files}.
1860
1861The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1862process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1863with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1864you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1865can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1866process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1867attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1868
1869@table @code
1870@kindex detach
1871@item detach
1872When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1873@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1874the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1875that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1876are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1877@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1878executing the command.
1879@end table
1880
1881If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1882attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1883for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1884control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1885confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1886messages}).
1887
6d2ebf8b 1888@node Kill Process
c906108c 1889@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1890
1891@table @code
1892@kindex kill
1893@item kill
1894Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1895@end table
1896
1897This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1898running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1899is running.
1900
1901On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1902while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1903@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1904outside the debugger.
1905
1906The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1907relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1908executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1909next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1910reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1911breakpoint settings).
1912
6d2ebf8b 1913@node Threads
c906108c 1914@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1915
1916@cindex threads of execution
1917@cindex multiple threads
1918@cindex switching threads
1919In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1920may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1921of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1922the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1923that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1924modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1925registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1926
1927@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1928programs:
1929
1930@itemize @bullet
1931@item automatic notification of new threads
1932@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1933@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 1934@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
1935a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1936@item thread-specific breakpoints
1937@end itemize
1938
c906108c
SS
1939@quotation
1940@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1941@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1942If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1943effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1944from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1945like this:
1946
1947@smallexample
1948(@value{GDBP}) info threads
1949(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1950Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1951see the IDs of currently known threads.
1952@end smallexample
1953@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1954@c doesn't support threads"?
1955@end quotation
c906108c
SS
1956
1957@cindex focus of debugging
1958@cindex current thread
1959The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1960threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1961control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1962This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1963program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1964
41afff9a 1965@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
1966@cindex thread identifier (system)
1967@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1968@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1969@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1970Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1971the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1972form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1973whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1974LynxOS, you might see
1975
1976@example
1977[New process 35 thread 27]
1978@end example
1979
1980@noindent
1981when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1982the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1983further qualifier.
1984
1985@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1986@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1987@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1988@c program?
1989@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1990@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 1991@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
1992
1993@cindex thread number
1994@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1995For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1996number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1997
1998@table @code
1999@kindex info threads
2000@item info threads
2001Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2002program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2003
2004@enumerate
2005@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2006
2007@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2008
2009@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2010@end enumerate
2011
2012@noindent
2013An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2014indicates the current thread.
2015
5d161b24 2016For example,
c906108c
SS
2017@end table
2018@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2019
2020@smallexample
2021(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2022 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2023 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2024* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2025 at threadtest.c:68
2026@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2027
2028On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2029
2030@cindex thread number
2031@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2032For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2033number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2034thread in your program.
2035
41afff9a
EZ
2036@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2037@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2038@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2039@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2040@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2041Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2042both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2043form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2044whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2045HP-UX, you see
2046
2047@example
2048[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2049@end example
2050
2051@noindent
5d161b24 2052when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2053
2054@table @code
2055@kindex info threads
2056@item info threads
2057Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2058program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2059
2060@enumerate
2061@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2062
2063@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2064
2065@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2066@end enumerate
2067
2068@noindent
2069An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2070indicates the current thread.
2071
5d161b24 2072For example,
c906108c
SS
2073@end table
2074@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2075
2076@example
2077(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2078 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2079 at quicksort.c:137
2080 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2081 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2082 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2083 from /usr/lib/libc.2
c906108c 2084@end example
c906108c
SS
2085
2086@table @code
2087@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2088@item thread @var{threadno}
2089Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2090argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2091shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2092@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2093you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2094
2095@smallexample
2096@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2097(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2098[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
20990x34e5 in sigpause ()
2100@end smallexample
2101
2102@noindent
2103As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2104@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2105threads.
c906108c
SS
2106
2107@kindex thread apply
2108@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2109The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2110more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2111with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2112@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2113threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2114@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2115@end table
2116
2117@cindex automatic thread selection
2118@cindex switching threads automatically
2119@cindex threads, automatic switching
2120Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2121signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2122signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2123message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2124thread.
2125
2126@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2127more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2128programs with multiple threads.
2129
2130@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2131watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2132
6d2ebf8b 2133@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2134@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2135
2136@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2137@cindex multiple processes
2138@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2139On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2140programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2141function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2142parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2143set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2144will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2145will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2146
2147However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2148which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2149the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2150only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2151so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2152on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2153get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2154@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2155the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2156the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2157
53a5351d
JM
2158On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2159debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2160@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2161
2162By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2163the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2164
2165If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2166use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2167
2168@table @code
2169@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2170@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2171Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2172@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2173process. The @var{mode} can be:
2174
2175@table @code
2176@item parent
2177The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2178unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2179
2180@item child
2181The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2182unimpeded.
2183
2184@item ask
2185The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2186@end table
2187
2188@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2189Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2190@end table
2191
2192If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2193@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2194breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2195@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2196the child process's @code{main}.
2197
2198When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2199child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2200
2201If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2202call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2203use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2204argument.
2205
2206You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2207a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2208Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2209
6d2ebf8b 2210@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2211@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2212
2213The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2214program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2215trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2216
7a292a7a
SS
2217Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2218such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2219@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2220change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2221continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2222ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2223explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2224
2225@table @code
2226@kindex info program
2227@item info program
2228Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2229running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2230@end table
2231
2232@menu
2233* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2234* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2235* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2236* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2237@end menu
2238
6d2ebf8b 2239@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2240@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2241
2242@cindex breakpoints
2243A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2244the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2245control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2246breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2247Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2248should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2249program.
2250
2251In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2252breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2253a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2254is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2255not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2256arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2257
2258@cindex watchpoints
2259@cindex memory tracing
2260@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2261@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2262A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2263when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2264command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2265watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2266any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2267and watchpoints using the same commands.
2268
2269You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2270whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2271Automatic display}.
2272
2273@cindex catchpoints
2274@cindex breakpoint on events
2275A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2276when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2277exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2278different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2279catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2280other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2281@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2282
2283@cindex breakpoint numbers
2284@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2285@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2286catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2287starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2288features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2289breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2290@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2291enable it again.
2292
c5394b80
JM
2293@cindex breakpoint ranges
2294@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2295Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2296operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2297@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2298hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2299all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2300
c906108c
SS
2301@menu
2302* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2303* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2304* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2305* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2306* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2307* Conditions:: Break conditions
2308* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2309* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2310* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2311@end menu
2312
6d2ebf8b 2313@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2314@subsection Setting breakpoints
2315
5d161b24 2316@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2317@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2318@c
2319@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2320
2321@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2322@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2323@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2324@cindex latest breakpoint
2325Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2326@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2327number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2328Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2329convenience variables.
2330
2331You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2332
2333@table @code
2334@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2335Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2336When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2337C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2338@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2339
2340@item break +@var{offset}
2341@itemx break -@var{offset}
2342Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2343at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2344(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2345
2346@item break @var{linenum}
2347Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2348The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2349The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2350code on that line.
2351
2352@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2353Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2354
2355@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2356Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2357@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2358superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2359functions.
2360
2361@item break *@var{address}
2362Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2363breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2364information or source files.
2365
2366@item break
2367When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2368the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2369(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2370innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2371returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2372@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2373that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2374@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2375the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2376inside loops.
2377
2378@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2379least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2380would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2381breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2382existed when your program stopped.
2383
2384@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2385Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2386@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2387value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2388@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2389above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2390,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2391
2392@kindex tbreak
2393@item tbreak @var{args}
2394Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2395same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2396way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2397program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2398
c906108c
SS
2399@kindex hbreak
2400@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2401Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2402@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2403breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2404have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2405debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2406changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2407provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2408will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2409address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2410breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2411example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2412@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2413or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2414(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2415
2416@kindex thbreak
2417@item thbreak @var{args}
2418Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2419are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2420the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2421the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2422first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2423command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2424may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2425See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2426
2427@kindex rbreak
2428@cindex regular expression
2429@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2430Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2431@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2432matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2433breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2434the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2435them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2436
2437The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2438like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2439shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2440an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2441@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2442match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2443
b37052ae 2444When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2445breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2446classes.
c906108c
SS
2447
2448@kindex info breakpoints
2449@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2450@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2451@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2452@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2453Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2454not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2455
2456@table @emph
2457@item Breakpoint Numbers
2458@item Type
2459Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2460@item Disposition
2461Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2462@item Enabled or Disabled
2463Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2464that are not enabled.
2465@item Address
2df3850c 2466Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2467@item What
2468Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2469line number.
2470@end table
2471
2472@noindent
2473If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2474the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2475are listed after that.
2476
2477@noindent
2478@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2479number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2480convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2481the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2482listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2483
2484@noindent
2485@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2486has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2487@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2488hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2489was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2490will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2491@end table
2492
2493@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2494your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2495the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2496(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2497
2498@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2499@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2500@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2501purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2502These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2503@code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2504
2505You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2506@samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2507
2508@table @code
2509@kindex maint info breakpoints
2510@item maint info breakpoints
2511Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2512breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2513internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2514breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2515is shown:
2516
2517@table @code
2518@item breakpoint
2519Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2520
2521@item watchpoint
2522Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2523
2524@item longjmp
2525Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2526@code{longjmp} calls.
2527
2528@item longjmp resume
2529Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2530
2531@item until
2532Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2533
2534@item finish
2535Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2536
c906108c
SS
2537@item shlib events
2538Shared library events.
53a5351d 2539
c906108c 2540@end table
53a5351d 2541
c906108c
SS
2542@end table
2543
2544
6d2ebf8b 2545@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2546@subsection Setting watchpoints
2547
2548@cindex setting watchpoints
2549@cindex software watchpoints
2550@cindex hardware watchpoints
2551You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2552expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2553this may happen.
2554
2555Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2556hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2557program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2558times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2559catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2560culprit.)
2561
d4f3574e 2562On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2563@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2564hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2565program.
2566
2567@table @code
2568@kindex watch
2569@item watch @var{expr}
2570Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2571is written into by the program and its value changes.
2572
2573@kindex rwatch
2574@item rwatch @var{expr}
2575Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2576
2577@kindex awatch
2578@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2579Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2580by the program.
c906108c
SS
2581
2582@kindex info watchpoints
2583@item info watchpoints
2584This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2585it is the same as @code{info break}.
2586@end table
2587
2588@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2589watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2590value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2591cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2592executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2593statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2594
2595When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2596
2597@example
2598Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2599@end example
2600
2601@noindent
2602if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2603
7be570e7
JM
2604Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2605hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2606value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2607every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2608that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2609hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2610will print a message like this:
2611
2612@smallexample
2613Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2614@end smallexample
2615
2616Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2617data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2618watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2619can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2620cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2621double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2622wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2623into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2624
2625If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2626to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2627Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2628time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2629able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2630warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2631
2632@smallexample
2633Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2634@end smallexample
2635
2636@noindent
2637If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2638
2639The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2640or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2641data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2642hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2643both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2644watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2645@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2646watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2647@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2648Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2649
2650If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2651any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2652kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2653
7be570e7
JM
2654@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2655(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2656they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2657which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2658being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2659and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2660rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2661way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2662@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2663
c906108c
SS
2664@quotation
2665@cindex watchpoints and threads
2666@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2667@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2668usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2669can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2670you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2671thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2672can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2673@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2674the expression.
53a5351d 2675
d4f3574e 2676@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2677@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2678have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2679watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2680single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2681change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2682confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2683software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2684when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2685watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2686@end quotation
c906108c 2687
6d2ebf8b 2688@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2689@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2690@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2691@cindex exception handlers
2692@cindex event handling
2693
2694You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2695kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2696shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2697
2698@table @code
2699@kindex catch
2700@item catch @var{event}
2701Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2702@table @code
2703@item throw
2704@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2705The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2706
2707@item catch
2708@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2709The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2710
2711@item exec
2712@kindex catch exec
2713A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2714
2715@item fork
2716@kindex catch fork
2717A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2718
2719@item vfork
2720@kindex catch vfork
2721A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2722
2723@item load
2724@itemx load @var{libname}
2725@kindex catch load
2726The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2727@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2728
2729@item unload
2730@itemx unload @var{libname}
2731@kindex catch unload
2732The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2733of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2734@end table
2735
2736@item tcatch @var{event}
2737Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2738automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2739
2740@end table
2741
2742Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2743
b37052ae 2744There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2745(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2746
2747@itemize @bullet
2748@item
2749If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2750control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2751raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2752returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2753simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2754that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2755you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2756disabled within interactive calls.
2757
2758@item
2759You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2760
2761@item
2762You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2763@end itemize
2764
2765@cindex raise exceptions
2766Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2767if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2768stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2769can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2770breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2771out where the exception was raised.
2772
2773To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2774knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2775raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2776which has the following ANSI C interface:
2777
2778@example
2779 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2780 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2781 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2782@end example
2783
2784@noindent
2785To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2786unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2787(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2788
2789With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2790that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2791a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2792breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2793raised.
2794
2795
6d2ebf8b 2796@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2797@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2798
2799@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2800@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2801It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2802catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2803to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2804breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2805
2806With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2807where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2808delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2809their breakpoint numbers.
2810
2811It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2812automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2813when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2814
2815@table @code
2816@kindex clear
2817@item clear
2818Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2819selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2820the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2821breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2822
2823@item clear @var{function}
2824@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2825Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2826
2827@item clear @var{linenum}
2828@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2829Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2830
2831@cindex delete breakpoints
2832@kindex delete
41afff9a 2833@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2834@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2835Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2836ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2837breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2838confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2839@end table
2840
6d2ebf8b 2841@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2842@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2843
2844@kindex disable breakpoints
2845@kindex enable breakpoints
2846Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2847prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2848it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2849that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2850
2851You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2852the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2853or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2854@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2855catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2856
2857A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2858states of enablement:
2859
2860@itemize @bullet
2861@item
2862Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2863with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2864@item
2865Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2866@item
2867Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2868disabled.
c906108c
SS
2869@item
2870Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2871immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2872set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2873@end itemize
2874
2875You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2876watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2877
2878@table @code
2879@kindex disable breakpoints
2880@kindex disable
41afff9a 2881@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2882@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2883Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2884listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2885options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2886case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2887@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2888
2889@kindex enable breakpoints
2890@kindex enable
c5394b80 2891@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2892Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2893become effective once again in stopping your program.
2894
c5394b80 2895@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2896Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2897of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2898
c5394b80 2899@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2900Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2901deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2902@end table
2903
d4f3574e
SS
2904@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2905@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2906Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2907,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2908subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2909the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2910breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2911breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2912stepping}.)
2913
6d2ebf8b 2914@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2915@subsection Break conditions
2916@cindex conditional breakpoints
2917@cindex breakpoint conditions
2918
2919@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2920@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2921The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2922specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2923breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2924programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2925a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2926and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2927
2928This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2929situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2930when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2931by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2932@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2933
2934Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2935since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2936it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2937and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2938one.
2939
2940Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2941your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2942that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2943format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2944unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2945that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2946program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2947breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2948conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2949purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2950(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2951
2952Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2953@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2954Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2955with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2956
c906108c
SS
2957You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2958The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2959@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2960catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
2961
2962@table @code
2963@kindex condition
2964@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2965Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2966watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2967breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2968@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2969@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2970syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
2971referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2972symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2973prints an error message:
2974
2975@example
2976No symbol "foo" in current context.
2977@end example
2978
2979@noindent
c906108c
SS
2980@value{GDBN} does
2981not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
2982command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2983@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
2984
2985@item condition @var{bnum}
2986Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2987an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2988@end table
2989
2990@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2991A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2992breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2993useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2994count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2995is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2996therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2997ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2998the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
2999value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3000your program reaches it.
3001
3002@table @code
3003@kindex ignore
3004@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3005Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3006The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3007execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3008takes no action.
3009
3010To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3011a count of zero.
3012
3013When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3014breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3015@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3016Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3017
3018If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3019condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3020@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3021
3022You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3023as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3024is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3025variables}.
3026@end table
3027
3028Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3029
3030
6d2ebf8b 3031@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3032@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3033
3034@cindex breakpoint commands
3035You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3036commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3037example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3038enable other breakpoints.
3039
3040@table @code
3041@kindex commands
3042@kindex end
3043@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3044@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3045@itemx end
3046Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3047themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3048@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3049
3050To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3051follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3052
3053With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3054breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3055recently encountered).
3056@end table
3057
3058Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3059disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3060
3061You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3062use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3063that resumes execution.
3064
3065Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3066execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3067(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3068another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3069ambiguities about which list to execute.
3070
3071@kindex silent
3072If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3073usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3074be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3075then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3076see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3077meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3078
3079The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3080print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3081breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3082
3083For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3084value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3085
3086@example
3087break foo if x>0
3088commands
3089silent
3090printf "x is %d\n",x
3091cont
3092end
3093@end example
3094
3095One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3096you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3097of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3098erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3099to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3100so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3101command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3102
3103@example
3104break 403
3105commands
3106silent
3107set x = y + 4
3108cont
3109end
3110@end example
3111
6d2ebf8b 3112@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3113@subsection Breakpoint menus
3114@cindex overloading
3115@cindex symbol overloading
3116
b37052ae 3117Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3118to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3119This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3120@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3121a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3122something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3123particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3124you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3125waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3126options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3127sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3128@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3129breakpoints.
3130
3131For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3132breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3133We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3134
3135@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3136@smallexample
3137@group
3138(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3139[0] cancel
3140[1] all
3141[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3142[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3143[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3144[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3145[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3146[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3147> 2 4 6
3148Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3149Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3150Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3151Multiple breakpoints were set.
3152Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3153 breakpoints.
3154(@value{GDBP})
3155@end group
3156@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3157
3158@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3159@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3160@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3161@c
3162@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3163@c
d4f3574e
SS
3164Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3165any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3166attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3167@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3168
3169@example
3170Cannot insert breakpoints.
3171The same program may be running in another process.
3172@end example
3173
3174When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3175
3176@enumerate
3177@item
3178Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3179
3180@item
5d161b24 3181Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3182name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3183that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3184Then start your program again.
3185
3186@item
3187Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3188linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3189to nonsharable executables.
3190@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3191@c @end ifclear
3192
d4f3574e
SS
3193A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3194hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3195
3196@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3197@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3198@smallexample
3199Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3200You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3201@end smallexample
3202
3203@noindent
3204This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3205only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3206watchpoints it needs to insert.
3207
3208When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3209hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3210
3211
6d2ebf8b 3212@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3213@section Continuing and stepping
3214
3215@cindex stepping
3216@cindex continuing
3217@cindex resuming execution
3218@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3219completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3220one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3221line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3222particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3223your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3224it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3225@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3226
3227@table @code
3228@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3229@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3230@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3231@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3232@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3233@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3234Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3235any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3236@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3237ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3238@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3239
3240The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3241stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3242@code{continue} is ignored.
3243
d4f3574e
SS
3244The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3245debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3246purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3247@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3248@end table
3249
3250To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3251(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3252calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3253different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3254
3255A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3256(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3257beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3258is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3259and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3260interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3261
3262@table @code
3263@kindex step
41afff9a 3264@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3265@item step
3266Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3267line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3268abbreviated @code{s}.
3269
3270@quotation
3271@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3272@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3273@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3274@c distinction here.
3275@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3276within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3277execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3278debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3279is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3280without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3281below.
3282@end quotation
3283
4a92d011
EZ
3284The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3285line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3286@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3287to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3288the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3289called within the line.
c906108c 3290
d4f3574e
SS
3291Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3292number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3293@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3294on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3295was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3296
3297@item step @var{count}
3298Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3299breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3300@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3301
3302@kindex next
41afff9a 3303@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3304@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3305Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3306This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3307the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3308control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3309that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3310is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3311
3312An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3313
3314
3315@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3316@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3317@c
3318@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3319@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3320@c function are executed without stopping.
3321
d4f3574e
SS
3322The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3323source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3324@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3325
b90a5f51
CF
3326@kindex set step-mode
3327@item set step-mode
3328@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3329@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3330@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3331The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3332stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3333information rather than stepping over it.
3334
4a92d011
EZ
3335This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3336machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3337want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3338
3339@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3340Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3341debug information. This is the default.
3342
c906108c
SS
3343@kindex finish
3344@item finish
3345Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3346returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3347
3348Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3349,Returning from a function}).
3350
3351@kindex until
41afff9a 3352@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3353@item until
3354@itemx u
3355Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3356current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3357stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3358command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3359automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3360than the address of the jump.
3361
3362This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3363though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3364exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3365simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3366through the next iteration.
3367
3368@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3369stack frame.
3370
3371@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3372of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3373example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3374(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3375@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3376
3377@example
3378(@value{GDBP}) f
3379#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3380206 expand_input();
3381(@value{GDBP}) until
3382195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3383@end example
3384
3385This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3386generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3387start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3388written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3389to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3390expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3391statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3392
3393@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3394instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3395argument.
3396
3397@item until @var{location}
3398@itemx u @var{location}
3399Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3400reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3401the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3402,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3403and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3404
3405@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3406@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3407@item stepi
96a2c332 3408@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3409@itemx si
3410Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3411
3412It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3413instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3414instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3415Display,, Automatic display}.
3416
3417An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3418
3419@need 750
3420@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3421@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3422@item nexti
96a2c332 3423@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3424@itemx ni
3425Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3426proceed until the function returns.
3427
3428An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3429@end table
3430
6d2ebf8b 3431@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3432@section Signals
3433@cindex signals
3434
3435A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3436operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3437kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3438signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3439@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3440memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3441the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3442requested an alarm).
3443
3444@cindex fatal signals
3445Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3446functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3447errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3448program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3449@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3450fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3451
3452@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3453program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3454signal.
3455
3456@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3457Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3458@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3459(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3460but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3461You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3462
3463@table @code
3464@kindex info signals
3465@item info signals
96a2c332 3466@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3467Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3468handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3469the defined types of signals.
3470
d4f3574e 3471@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3472
3473@kindex handle
3474@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3475Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3476can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3477@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3478@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3479known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3480@end table
3481
3482@c @group
3483The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3484Their full names are:
3485
3486@table @code
3487@item nostop
3488@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3489still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3490
3491@item stop
3492@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3493the @code{print} keyword as well.
3494
3495@item print
3496@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3497
3498@item noprint
3499@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3500implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3501
3502@item pass
5ece1a18 3503@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3504@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3505can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3506and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3507
3508@item nopass
5ece1a18 3509@itemx ignore
c906108c 3510@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3511@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3512@end table
3513@c @end group
3514
d4f3574e
SS
3515When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3516program until you
c906108c
SS
3517continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3518effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3519after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3520command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3521program sees that signal when you continue.
3522
24f93129
EZ
3523The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3524non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3525@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3526erroneous signals.
3527
c906108c
SS
3528You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3529seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3530or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3531due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3532values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3533execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3534a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3535you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3536program a signal}.
c906108c 3537
6d2ebf8b 3538@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3539@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3540
3541When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3542programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3543breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3544
3545@table @code
3546@cindex breakpoints and threads
3547@cindex thread breakpoints
3548@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3549@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3550@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3551@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3552writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3553
3554Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3555to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3556particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3557numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3558column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3559
3560If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3561breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3562program.
3563
3564You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3565well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3566breakpoint condition, like this:
3567
3568@smallexample
2df3850c 3569(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3570@end smallexample
3571
3572@end table
3573
3574@cindex stopped threads
3575@cindex threads, stopped
3576Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3577@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3578allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3579switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3580underfoot.
3581
3582@cindex continuing threads
3583@cindex threads, continuing
3584Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3585executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3586like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3587
3588In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3589Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3590system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3591execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3592single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3593statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3594stops.
3595
3596You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3597continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3598thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3599first thread completes whatever you requested.
3600
3601On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3602thread to run.
3603
3604@table @code
3605@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3606Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3607locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3608current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3609mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3610``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3611stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3612when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3613function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3614like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3615thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3616@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3617
3618@item show scheduler-locking
3619Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3620@end table
3621
c906108c 3622
6d2ebf8b 3623@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3624@chapter Examining the Stack
3625
3626When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3627stopped and how it got there.
3628
3629@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3630Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3631is generated.
3632That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3633the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3634and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3635The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3636The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3637stack}.
3638
3639When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3640stack allow you to see all of this information.
3641
3642@cindex selected frame
3643One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3644@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3645particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3646your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3647special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3648interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3649
3650When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3651currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3652@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3653
3654@menu
3655* Frames:: Stack frames
3656* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3657* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3658* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3659
3660@end menu
3661
6d2ebf8b 3662@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3663@section Stack frames
3664
d4f3574e 3665@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3666@cindex stack frame
3667The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3668frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3669with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3670to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3671which the function is executing.
3672
3673@cindex initial frame
3674@cindex outermost frame
3675@cindex innermost frame
3676When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3677function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3678@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3679made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3680is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3681the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3682actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3683recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3684
3685@cindex frame pointer
3686Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3687stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3688kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3689address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3690in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3691going on in that frame.
3692
3693@cindex frame number
3694@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3695zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3696and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3697they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3698frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3699
6d2ebf8b
SS
3700@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3701@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3702@cindex frameless execution
3703Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b
SS
3704without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3705@example
3706@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3707@end example
3708generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3709This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3710the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3711with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3712has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3713it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3714correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3715no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3716
3717@table @code
d4f3574e 3718@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3719@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3720@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3721The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3722and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3723address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3724@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3725
3726@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3727@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3728@item select-frame
3729The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3730to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3731@code{frame}.
3732@end table
3733
6d2ebf8b 3734@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3735@section Backtraces
3736
3737@cindex backtraces
3738@cindex tracebacks
3739@cindex stack traces
3740A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3741line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3742frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3743stack.
3744
3745@table @code
3746@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3747@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3748@item backtrace
3749@itemx bt
3750Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3751frames in the stack.
3752
3753You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3754character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3755
3756@item backtrace @var{n}
3757@itemx bt @var{n}
3758Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3759
3760@item backtrace -@var{n}
3761@itemx bt -@var{n}
3762Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3763@end table
3764
3765@kindex where
3766@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3767@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3768The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3769are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3770
3771Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3772The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3773print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3774line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3775counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3776line number.
3777
3778Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3779@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3780
3781@smallexample
3782@group
5d161b24 3783#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3784 at builtin.c:993
3785#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3786#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3787 at macro.c:71
3788(More stack frames follow...)
3789@end group
3790@end smallexample
3791
3792@noindent
3793The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3794value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3795code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3796
6d2ebf8b 3797@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3798@section Selecting a frame
3799
3800Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3801whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3802selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3803of the stack frame just selected.
3804
3805@table @code
d4f3574e 3806@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3807@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3808@item frame @var{n}
3809@itemx f @var{n}
3810Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3811(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3812innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3813@code{main}.
3814
3815@item frame @var{addr}
3816@itemx f @var{addr}
3817Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3818chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3819impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3820addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3821switches between them.
3822
c906108c
SS
3823On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3824select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3825
3826On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3827pointer and a program counter.
3828
3829On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3830pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3831@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3832@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3833@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3834
3835@kindex up
3836@item up @var{n}
3837Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3838advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3839that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3840
3841@kindex down
41afff9a 3842@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3843@item down @var{n}
3844Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3845advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3846that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3847abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3848@end table
3849
3850All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3851frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3852arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3853frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3854
3855@need 1000
3856For example:
3857
3858@smallexample
3859@group
3860(@value{GDBP}) up
3861#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3862 at env.c:10
386310 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3864@end group
3865@end smallexample
3866
3867After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3868prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3869@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3870
3871@table @code
3872@kindex down-silently
3873@kindex up-silently
3874@item up-silently @var{n}
3875@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3876These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3877respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3878causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3879in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3880distracting.
3881@end table
3882
6d2ebf8b 3883@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3884@section Information about a frame
3885
3886There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3887stack frame.
3888
3889@table @code
3890@item frame
3891@itemx f
3892When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3893frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3894selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3895argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3896@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3897
3898@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3899@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3900@item info frame
3901@itemx info f
3902This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3903including:
3904
3905@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3906@item
3907the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3908@item
3909the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3910@item
3911the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3912@item
3913the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3914@item
3915the address of the frame's arguments
3916@item
d4f3574e
SS
3917the address of the frame's local variables
3918@item
c906108c
SS
3919the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3920@item
3921which registers were saved in the frame
3922@end itemize
3923
3924@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3925something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3926the usual conventions.
3927
3928@item info frame @var{addr}
3929@itemx info f @var{addr}
3930Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3931selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3932command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3933architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3934@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3935
3936@kindex info args
3937@item info args
3938Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3939
3940@item info locals
3941@kindex info locals
3942Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3943line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3944accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3945
c906108c 3946@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3947@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3948@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3949@item info catch
3950Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3951current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3952exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3953@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3954@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3955
c906108c
SS
3956@end table
3957
c906108c 3958
6d2ebf8b 3959@node Source
c906108c
SS
3960@chapter Examining Source Files
3961
3962@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3963information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3964used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3965the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3966(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3967execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3968source files by explicit command.
3969
7a292a7a 3970If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 3971prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 3972@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
3973
3974@menu
3975* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 3976* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
3977* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3978* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3979@end menu
3980
6d2ebf8b 3981@node List
c906108c
SS
3982@section Printing source lines
3983
3984@kindex list
41afff9a 3985@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 3986To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 3987(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
3988There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3989
3990Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3991
3992@table @code
3993@item list @var{linenum}
3994Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3995current source file.
3996
3997@item list @var{function}
3998Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3999@var{function}.
4000
4001@item list
4002Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4003@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4004printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4005as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4006Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4007
4008@item list -
4009Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4010@end table
4011
4012By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4013the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4014
4015@table @code
4016@kindex set listsize
4017@item set listsize @var{count}
4018Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4019the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4020
4021@kindex show listsize
4022@item show listsize
4023Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4024@end table
4025
4026Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4027so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4028than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4029argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4030each repetition moves up in the source file.
4031
4032@cindex linespec
4033In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4034@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4035of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4036Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4037
4038@table @code
4039@item list @var{linespec}
4040Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4041
4042@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4043Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4044linespecs.
4045
4046@item list ,@var{last}
4047Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4048
4049@item list @var{first},
4050Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4051
4052@item list +
4053Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4054
4055@item list -
4056Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4057
4058@item list
4059As described in the preceding table.
4060@end table
4061
4062Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4063kinds of linespec.
4064
4065@table @code
4066@item @var{number}
4067Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4068When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4069the same source file as the first linespec.
4070
4071@item +@var{offset}
4072Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4073When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4074two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4075first linespec.
4076
4077@item -@var{offset}
4078Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4079
4080@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4081Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4082
4083@item @var{function}
4084Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4085For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4086
4087@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4088Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4089function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4090file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4091identically named functions in different source files.
4092
4093@item *@var{address}
4094Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4095@var{address} may be any expression.
4096@end table
4097
6d2ebf8b 4098@node Search
c906108c
SS
4099@section Searching source files
4100@cindex searching
4101@kindex reverse-search
4102
4103There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4104regular expression.
4105
4106@table @code
4107@kindex search
4108@kindex forward-search
4109@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4110@itemx search @var{regexp}
4111The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4112starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4113@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4114synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4115@code{fo}.
4116
4117@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4118The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4119with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4120for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4121this command as @code{rev}.
4122@end table
c906108c 4123
6d2ebf8b 4124@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4125@section Specifying source directories
4126
4127@cindex source path
4128@cindex directories for source files
4129Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4130files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4131the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4132session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4133this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4134it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4135in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4136the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4137the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4138path.
4139
4140If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4141object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4142too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4143compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4144last resort.
4145
4146Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4147any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4148each line is in the file.
4149
4150@kindex directory
4151@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4152When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4153and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4154To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4155
4156@table @code
4157@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4158@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4159Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4160directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4161(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4162part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4163whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4164path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4165
4166@kindex cdir
4167@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4168@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4169@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4170@cindex compilation directory
4171@cindex current directory
4172@cindex working directory
4173@cindex directory, current
4174@cindex directory, compilation
4175You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4176directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4177working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4178tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4179session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4180directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4181
4182@item directory
4183Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4184
4185@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4186@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4187
4188@item show directories
4189@kindex show directories
4190Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4191@end table
4192
4193If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4194interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4195versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4196
4197@enumerate
4198@item
4199Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4200
4201@item
4202Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4203directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4204directories in one command.
4205@end enumerate
4206
6d2ebf8b 4207@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4208@section Source and machine code
4209
4210You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4211addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4212a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4213mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4214line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4215well as hex.
4216
4217@table @code
4218@kindex info line
4219@item info line @var{linespec}
4220Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4221source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4222the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4223source lines}).
4224@end table
4225
4226For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4227the object code for the first line of function
4228@code{m4_changequote}:
4229
d4f3574e
SS
4230@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4231@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4232@smallexample
96a2c332 4233(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4234Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4235@end smallexample
4236
4237@noindent
4238We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4239@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4240@smallexample
4241(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4242Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4243@end smallexample
4244
4245@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4246@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4247After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4248is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4249sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4250,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4251convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4252variables}).
4253
4254@table @code
4255@kindex disassemble
4256@cindex assembly instructions
4257@cindex instructions, assembly
4258@cindex machine instructions
4259@cindex listing machine instructions
4260@item disassemble
4261This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4262instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4263program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4264command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4265surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4266(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4267@end table
4268
c906108c
SS
4269The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4270HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4271
4272@smallexample
4273(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4274Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
42750x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
42760x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
42770x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
42780x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
42790x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
42800x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
42810x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
42820x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4283End of assembler dump.
4284@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4285
4286Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4287mnemonics or other syntax.
4288
4289@table @code
d4f3574e 4290@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4291@cindex assembly instructions
4292@cindex instructions, assembly
4293@cindex machine instructions
4294@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4295@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4296@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4297@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4298Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4299program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4300
4301Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4302can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4303The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4304assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4305@end table
4306
4307
6d2ebf8b 4308@node Data
c906108c
SS
4309@chapter Examining Data
4310
4311@cindex printing data
4312@cindex examining data
4313@kindex print
4314@kindex inspect
4315@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4316@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4317@c different window or something like that.
4318The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4319command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4320evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4321program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4322Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4323
4324@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4325@item print @var{expr}
4326@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4327@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4328value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4329you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4330@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4331formats}.
4332
4333@item print
4334@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4335If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4336@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4337conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4338@end table
4339
4340A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4341It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4342specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4343
7a292a7a 4344If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4345fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4346command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4347Table}.
c906108c
SS
4348
4349@menu
4350* Expressions:: Expressions
4351* Variables:: Program variables
4352* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4353* Output Formats:: Output formats
4354* Memory:: Examining memory
4355* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4356* Print Settings:: Print settings
4357* Value History:: Value history
4358* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4359* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4360* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
29e57380 4361* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
c906108c
SS
4362@end menu
4363
6d2ebf8b 4364@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4365@section Expressions
4366
4367@cindex expressions
4368@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4369compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4370by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4371@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4372and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4373by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4374
d4f3574e
SS
4375@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4376the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4377you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4378memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4379
c906108c
SS
4380Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4381this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4382Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4383languages.
4384
4385In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4386expressions regardless of your programming language.
4387
4388Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4389useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4390at that address in memory.
4391@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4392
4393@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4394to programming languages:
4395
4396@table @code
4397@item @@
4398@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4399@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4400
4401@item ::
4402@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4403function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4404
4405@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4406@cindex type casting memory
4407@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4408@cindex casts, to view memory
4409@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4410Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4411memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4412pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4413a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4414normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4415@end table
4416
6d2ebf8b 4417@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4418@section Program variables
4419
4420The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4421in your program.
4422
4423Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4424(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4425
4426@itemize @bullet
4427@item
4428global (or file-static)
4429@end itemize
4430
5d161b24 4431@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4432
4433@itemize @bullet
4434@item
4435visible according to the scope rules of the
4436programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4437@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4438
4439@noindent This means that in the function
4440
4441@example
4442foo (a)
4443 int a;
4444@{
4445 bar (a);
4446 @{
4447 int b = test ();
4448 bar (b);
4449 @}
4450@}
4451@end example
4452
4453@noindent
4454you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4455executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4456examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4457the block where @code{b} is declared.
4458
4459@cindex variable name conflict
4460There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4461scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4462in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4463function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4464happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4465you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4466using the colon-colon notation:
4467
d4f3574e 4468@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4469@iftex
4470@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4471@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4472@end iftex
4473@example
4474@var{file}::@var{variable}
4475@var{function}::@var{variable}
4476@end example
4477
4478@noindent
4479Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4480static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4481make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4482to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4483
4484@example
4485(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4486@end example
4487
b37052ae 4488@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4489This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4490use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4491scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4492@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4493@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4494
4495@cindex wrong values
4496@cindex variable values, wrong
4497@quotation
4498@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4499wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4500scope, and just before exit.
4501@end quotation
4502You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4503This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4504set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4505stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4506values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4507also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4508after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4509variable definitions may be gone.
4510
4511This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4512To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4513when compiling.
4514
d4f3574e
SS
4515@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4516Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4517unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4518opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4519offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4520might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4521happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4522
4523@example
4524No symbol "foo" in current context.
4525@end example
4526
4527To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4528different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4529formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4530supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4531in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4532to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4533debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4534Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4535information.
4536
4537
6d2ebf8b 4538@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4539@section Artificial arrays
4540
4541@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4542@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4543It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4544same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4545dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4546program.
4547
4548You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4549@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4550operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4551and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4552of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4553the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4554argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4555following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4556example. If a program says
4557
4558@example
4559int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4560@end example
4561
4562@noindent
4563you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4564
4565@example
4566p *array@@len
4567@end example
4568
4569The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4570with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4571subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4572Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4573(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4574
4575Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4576This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4577The value need not be in memory:
4578@example
4579(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4580$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4581@end example
4582
4583As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4584@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4585the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4586@example
4587(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4588$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4589@end example
4590
4591Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4592moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4593actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4594of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4595to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4596variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4597interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4598instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4599structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4600in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4601
4602@example
4603set $i = 0
4604p dtab[$i++]->fv
4605@key{RET}
4606@key{RET}
4607@dots{}
4608@end example
4609
6d2ebf8b 4610@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4611@section Output formats
4612
4613@cindex formatted output
4614@cindex output formats
4615By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4616this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4617in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4618at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4619these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4620
4621The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4622already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4623@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4624letters supported are:
4625
4626@table @code
4627@item x
4628Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4629hexadecimal.
4630
4631@item d
4632Print as integer in signed decimal.
4633
4634@item u
4635Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4636
4637@item o
4638Print as integer in octal.
4639
4640@item t
4641Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4642@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4643used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4644see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4645
4646@item a
4647@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4648@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4649Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4650the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4651where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4652
4653@example
4654(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4655$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4656@end example
4657
3d67e040
EZ
4658@noindent
4659The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4660@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4661
c906108c
SS
4662@item c
4663Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4664
4665@item f
4666Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4667using typical floating point syntax.
4668@end table
4669
4670For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4671
4672@example
4673p/x $pc
4674@end example
4675
4676@noindent
4677Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4678names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4679
4680To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4681you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4682expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4683
6d2ebf8b 4684@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4685@section Examining memory
4686
4687You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4688any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4689
4690@cindex examining memory
4691@table @code
41afff9a 4692@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4693@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4694@itemx x @var{addr}
4695@itemx x
4696Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4697@end table
4698
4699@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4700much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4701expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4702If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4703Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4704
4705@table @r
4706@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4707The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4708how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4709@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4710@c 4.1.2.
4711
4712@item @var{f}, the display format
4713The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4714@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4715The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4716The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4717
4718@item @var{u}, the unit size
4719The unit size is any of
4720
4721@table @code
4722@item b
4723Bytes.
4724@item h
4725Halfwords (two bytes).
4726@item w
4727Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4728@item g
4729Giant words (eight bytes).
4730@end table
4731
4732Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4733default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4734@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4735
4736@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4737@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4738memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4739it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4740@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4741@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4742other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4743the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4744starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4745a value from memory).
4746@end table
4747
4748For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4749(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4750starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4751words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4752@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4753
4754Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4755letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4756unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4757specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4758(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4759
4760Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4761and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4762@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4763including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4764alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4765Code,,Source and machine code}.
4766
4767All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4768easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4769you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4770instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4771with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4772the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4773for successive uses of @code{x}.
4774
4775@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4776The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4777in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4778would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4779subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4780@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4781examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4782@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4783the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4784
4785If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4786are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4787address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4788
6d2ebf8b 4789@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4790@section Automatic display
4791@cindex automatic display
4792@cindex display of expressions
4793
4794If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4795(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4796display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4797Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4798to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4799The automatic display looks like this:
4800
4801@example
48022: foo = 38
48033: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4804@end example
4805
4806@noindent
4807This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4808displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4809specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4810whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4811format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4812or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4813supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4814
4815@table @code
4816@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4817@item display @var{expr}
4818Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4819each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4820
4821@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4822
d4f3574e 4823@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4824For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4825count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4826arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4827@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4828
4829@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4830For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4831number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4832be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4833doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4834@end table
4835
4836For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4837instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4838is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4839
4840@table @code
4841@kindex delete display
4842@kindex undisplay
4843@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4844@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4845Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4846
4847@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4848(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4849
4850@kindex disable display
4851@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4852Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4853item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4854enabled again later.
4855
4856@kindex enable display
4857@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4858Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4859again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4860
4861@item display
4862Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4863done when your program stops.
4864
4865@kindex info display
4866@item info display
4867Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4868automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4869values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4870It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4871because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4872@end table
4873
4874If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4875sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4876expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4877variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4878@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4879@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4880continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4881there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4882automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4883is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4884
6d2ebf8b 4885@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4886@section Print settings
4887
4888@cindex format options
4889@cindex print settings
4890@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4891and symbols are printed.
4892
4893@noindent
4894These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4895
4896@table @code
4897@kindex set print address
4898@item set print address
4899@itemx set print address on
4900@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4901traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4902even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4903is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4904@code{set print address on}:
4905
4906@smallexample
4907@group
4908(@value{GDBP}) f
4909#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4910 at input.c:530
4911530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4912@end group
4913@end smallexample
4914
4915@item set print address off
4916Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4917this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4918
4919@smallexample
4920@group
4921(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4922(@value{GDBP}) f
4923#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4924530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4925@end group
4926@end smallexample
4927
4928You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4929dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4930@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4931all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4932
4933@kindex show print address
4934@item show print address
4935Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4936@end table
4937
4938When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4939closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4940identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4941source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4942@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4943you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4944it prints a symbolic address:
4945
4946@table @code
4947@kindex set print symbol-filename
4948@item set print symbol-filename on
4949Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4950symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4951
4952@item set print symbol-filename off
4953Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4954default.
4955
4956@kindex show print symbol-filename
4957@item show print symbol-filename
4958Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4959line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4960@end table
4961
4962Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4963numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4964number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4965
4966Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4967printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4968
4969@table @code
4970@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4971@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4972Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4973offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 4974@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
4975to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4976
4977@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4978@item show print max-symbolic-offset
4979Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4980symbolic address.
4981@end table
4982
4983@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4984@cindex pointer, finding referent
4985If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4986@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4987and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4988@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4989For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4990at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4991
4992@example
4993(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4994(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4995$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4996@end example
4997
4998@quotation
4999@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5000does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5001the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5002@end quotation
5003
5004Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5005
5006@table @code
5007@kindex set print array
5008@item set print array
5009@itemx set print array on
5010Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5011but uses more space. The default is off.
5012
5013@item set print array off
5014Return to compressed format for arrays.
5015
5016@kindex show print array
5017@item show print array
5018Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5019arrays.
5020
5021@kindex set print elements
5022@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5023Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5024If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5025printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5026This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5027When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5028Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5029
5030@kindex show print elements
5031@item show print elements
5032Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5033If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5034
5035@kindex set print null-stop
5036@item set print null-stop
5037Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5038@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5039contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5040The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5041
5042@kindex set print pretty
5043@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5044Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5045per line, like this:
5046
5047@smallexample
5048@group
5049$1 = @{
5050 next = 0x0,
5051 flags = @{
5052 sweet = 1,
5053 sour = 1
5054 @},
5055 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5056@}
5057@end group
5058@end smallexample
5059
5060@item set print pretty off
5061Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5062
5063@smallexample
5064@group
5065$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5066meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5067@end group
5068@end smallexample
5069
5070@noindent
5071This is the default format.
5072
5073@kindex show print pretty
5074@item show print pretty
5075Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5076
5077@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5078@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5079Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5080@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5081character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5082best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5083high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5084
5085@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5086Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5087international character sets, and is the default.
5088
5089@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5090@item show print sevenbit-strings
5091Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5092
5093@kindex set print union
5094@item set print union on
5d161b24 5095Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5096is the default setting.
5097
5098@item set print union off
5099Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5100
5101@kindex show print union
5102@item show print union
5103Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5104structures.
5105
5106For example, given the declarations
5107
5108@smallexample
5109typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5110typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5111typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5112 Bug_forms;
5113
5114struct thing @{
5115 Species it;
5116 union @{
5117 Tree_forms tree;
5118 Bug_forms bug;
5119 @} form;
5120@};
5121
5122struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5123@end smallexample
5124
5125@noindent
5126with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5127
5128@smallexample
5129$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5130@end smallexample
5131
5132@noindent
5133and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5134
5135@smallexample
5136$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5137@end smallexample
5138@end table
5139
c906108c
SS
5140@need 1000
5141@noindent
b37052ae 5142These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5143
5144@table @code
5145@cindex demangling
5146@kindex set print demangle
5147@item set print demangle
5148@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5149Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5150(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5151linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5152
5153@kindex show print demangle
5154@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5155Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5156
5157@kindex set print asm-demangle
5158@item set print asm-demangle
5159@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5160Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5161in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5162The default is off.
5163
5164@kindex show print asm-demangle
5165@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5166Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5167or demangled form.
5168
5169@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5170@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5171@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5172@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5173Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5174represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5175
5176@table @code
5177@item auto
5178Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5179
5180@item gnu
b37052ae 5181Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5182This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5183
5184@item hp
b37052ae 5185Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5186
5187@item lucid
b37052ae 5188Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5189
5190@item arm
b37052ae 5191Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5192@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5193debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5194require further enhancement to permit that.
5195
5196@end table
5197If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5198
5199@kindex show demangle-style
5200@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5201Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5202
5203@kindex set print object
5204@item set print object
5205@itemx set print object on
5206When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5207(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5208the virtual function table.
5209
5210@item set print object off
5211Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5212virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5213
5214@kindex show print object
5215@item show print object
5216Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5217
5218@kindex set print static-members
5219@item set print static-members
5220@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5221Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5222
5223@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5224Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5225
5226@kindex show print static-members
5227@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5228Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5229
5230@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5231@kindex set print vtbl
5232@item set print vtbl
5233@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5234Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5235(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5236ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5237
5238@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5239Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5240
5241@kindex show print vtbl
5242@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5243Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5244@end table
c906108c 5245
6d2ebf8b 5246@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5247@section Value history
5248
5249@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5250Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5251@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5252Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5253(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5254When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5255since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5256symbol table.
5257
5258@cindex @code{$}
5259@cindex @code{$$}
5260@cindex history number
5261The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5262refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5263@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5264printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5265history number.
5266
5267To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5268history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5269remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5270the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5271@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5272is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5273@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5274
5275For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5276want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5277
5278@example
5279p *$
5280@end example
5281
5282If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5283to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5284
5285@example
5286p *$.next
5287@end example
5288
5289@noindent
5290You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5291command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5292
5293Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5294@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5295
5296@example
5297print x
5298set x=5
5299@end example
5300
5301@noindent
5302then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5303remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5304
5305@table @code
5306@kindex show values
5307@item show values
5308Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5309This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5310values} does not change the history.
5311
5312@item show values @var{n}
5313Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5314
5315@item show values +
5316Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5317values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5318@end table
5319
5320Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5321same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5322
6d2ebf8b 5323@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5324@section Convenience variables
5325
5326@cindex convenience variables
5327@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5328@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5329exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5330setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5331of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5332
5333Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5334@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5335the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5336(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5337by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5338
5339You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5340expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5341For example:
5342
5343@example
5344set $foo = *object_ptr
5345@end example
5346
5347@noindent
5348would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5349@code{object_ptr}.
5350
5351Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5352value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5353value with another assignment at any time.
5354
5355Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5356variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5357that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5358variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5359
5360@table @code
5361@kindex show convenience
5362@item show convenience
5363Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5364Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5365@end table
5366
5367One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5368incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5369a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5370
5371@example
5372set $i = 0
5373print bar[$i++]->contents
5374@end example
5375
d4f3574e
SS
5376@noindent
5377Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5378
5379Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5380values likely to be useful.
5381
5382@table @code
41afff9a 5383@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5384@item $_
5385The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5386the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5387commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5388set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5389and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5390except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5391to the type of @code{$__}.
5392
41afff9a 5393@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5394@item $__
5395The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5396to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5397to match the format in which the data was printed.
5398
5399@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5400@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5401The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5402the program being debugged terminates.
5403@end table
5404
53a5351d
JM
5405On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5406begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5407name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5408
6d2ebf8b 5409@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5410@section Registers
5411
5412@cindex registers
5413You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5414with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5415for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5416your machine.
5417
5418@table @code
5419@kindex info registers
5420@item info registers
5421Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5422registers (in the selected stack frame).
5423
5424@kindex info all-registers
5425@cindex floating point registers
5426@item info all-registers
5427Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5428registers.
5429
5430@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5431Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5432As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5433the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5434the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5435@end table
5436
5437@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5438expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5439architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5440@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5441the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5442pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5443register that contains the processor status. For example,
5444you could print the program counter in hex with
5445
5446@example
5447p/x $pc
5448@end example
5449
5450@noindent
5451or print the instruction to be executed next with
5452
5453@example
5454x/i $pc
5455@end example
5456
5457@noindent
5458or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5459one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5460memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5461stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5462stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5463regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5464see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5465
5466@example
5467set $sp += 4
5468@end example
5469
5470Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5471your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5472so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5473shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5474registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5475can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5476is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5477
5478@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5479integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5480special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5481registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5482to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5483(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5484@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5485
5486Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5487means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5488the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5489sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5490coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5491programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5492cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5493that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5494prints the data in both formats.
5495
5496Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5497(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5498value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5499were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5500true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5501frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5502
5503However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5504code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5505@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5506frame makes no difference.
5507
6d2ebf8b 5508@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5509@section Floating point hardware
5510@cindex floating point
5511
5512Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5513you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5514
5515@table @code
5516@kindex info float
5517@item info float
5518Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5519point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5520floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5521the ARM and x86 machines.
5522@end table
c906108c 5523
29e57380
C
5524@node Memory Region Attributes
5525@section Memory Region Attributes
5526@cindex memory region attributes
5527
5528@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5529required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5530to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5531use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5532
5533Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5534memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5535accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5536been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5537all memory.
5538
5539When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5540to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5541
5542@table @code
5543@kindex mem
5544@item mem @var{address1} @var{address1} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5545Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5546with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5547
5548@kindex delete mem
5549@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5550Remove memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5551
5552@kindex disable mem
5553@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5554Disable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5555A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5556It may be enabled again later.
5557
5558@kindex enable mem
5559@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5560Enable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5561
5562@kindex info mem
5563@item info mem
5564Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5565for each region.
5566
5567@table @emph
5568@item Memory Region Number
5569@item Enabled or Disabled.
5570Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5571Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5572
5573@item Lo Address
5574The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5575
5576@item Hi Address
5577The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5578
5579@item Attributes
5580The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5581@end table
5582@end table
5583
5584
5585@subsection Attributes
5586
5587@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5588The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5589write accesses to a memory region.
5590
5591While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5592memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5593etc. from accessing memory.
5594
5595@table @code
5596@item ro
5597Memory is read only.
5598@item wo
5599Memory is write only.
5600@item rw
5601Memory is read/write (default).
5602@end table
5603
5604@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5605The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5606accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5607require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5608specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5609
5610@table @code
5611@item 8
5612Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5613@item 16
5614Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5615@item 32
5616Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5617@item 64
5618Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5619@end table
5620
5621@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5622@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5623@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5624@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5625@c
5626@c @table @code
5627@c @item hwbreak
5628@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5629@c @item swbreak (default)
5630@c @end table
5631
5632@subsubsection Data Cache
5633The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5634memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5635protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5636does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5637registers.
5638
5639@table @code
5640@item cache
5641Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5642@item nocache (default)
5643Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory.
5644@end table
5645
5646@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5647@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5648@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5649@c
5650@c @table @code
5651@c @item verify
5652@c @item noverify (default)
5653@c @end table
5654
b37052ae
EZ
5655@node Tracepoints
5656@chapter Tracepoints
5657@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
5658@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
5659
5660@cindex tracepoints
5661In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
5662the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
5663anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
5664depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
5665might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
5666fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
5667to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
5668
5669Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
5670specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
5671arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
5672Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
5673those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
5674expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
5675for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
5676a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
5677in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
5678values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
5679unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
5680
5681The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
5682targets. @xref{Targets}.
5683
5684This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
5685
5686@menu
5687* Set Tracepoints::
5688* Analyze Collected Data::
5689* Tracepoint Variables::
5690@end menu
5691
5692@node Set Tracepoints
5693@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
5694
5695Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
5696tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
5697tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
5698breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
5699one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
5700tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
5701work on.
5702
5703For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
5704of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
5705it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
5706local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
5707commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
5708tracepoint was hit.
5709
5710This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
5711conditions and actions.
5712
5713@menu
5714* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
5715* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
5716* Tracepoint Passcounts::
5717* Tracepoint Actions::
5718* Listing Tracepoints::
5719* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
5720@end menu
5721
5722@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
5723@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
5724
5725@table @code
5726@cindex set tracepoint
5727@kindex trace
5728@item trace
5729The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
5730Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
5731the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
5732defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
5733debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
5734program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
5735doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
5736cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
5737running.
5738
5739Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
5740
5741@smallexample
5742(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
5743
5744(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
5745
5746(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
5747
5748(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
5749
5750(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
5751@end smallexample
5752
5753@noindent
5754You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
5755
5756@vindex $tpnum
5757@cindex last tracepoint number
5758@cindex recent tracepoint number
5759@cindex tracepoint number
5760The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
5761of the most recently set tracepoint.
5762
5763@kindex delete tracepoint
5764@cindex tracepoint deletion
5765@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5766Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
5767default is to delete all tracepoints.
5768
5769Examples:
5770
5771@smallexample
5772(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
5773
5774(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
5775@end smallexample
5776
5777@noindent
5778You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
5779@end table
5780
5781@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5782@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5783
5784@table @code
5785@kindex disable tracepoint
5786@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5787Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
5788@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
5789the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
5790a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
5791
5792@kindex enable tracepoint
5793@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5794Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
5795tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
5796run.
5797@end table
5798
5799@node Tracepoint Passcounts
5800@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
5801
5802@table @code
5803@kindex passcount
5804@cindex tracepoint pass count
5805@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
5806Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
5807automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
5808@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
5809the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
5810@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
5811passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
5812given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
5813user.
5814
5815Examples:
5816
5817@smallexample
5818(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of tracepoint 2
5819
5820(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
5821 // most recently defined tracepoint.
5822(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5823(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
5824(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
5825(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
5826(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
5827(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
5828 // executed 3 times OR when bar has
5829 // been executed 2 times
5830 // OR when baz has been executed 1 time.
5831@end smallexample
5832@end table
5833
5834@node Tracepoint Actions
5835@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
5836
5837@table @code
5838@kindex actions
5839@cindex tracepoint actions
5840@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5841This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
5842tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
5843specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
5844recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
5845@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
5846actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
5847terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
5848far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
5849@code{while-stepping}.
5850
5851@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
5852To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
5853and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
5854
5855@smallexample
5856(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
5857
5858(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times and collect data
5859
5860(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
5861@end smallexample
5862
5863In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
5864commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
5865hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
5866following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
5867followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
5868@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
5869@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
5870@code{end} command.
5871
5872@smallexample
5873(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5874(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
5875Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
5876> collect bar,baz
5877> collect $regs
5878> while-stepping 12
5879 > collect $fp, $sp
5880 > end
5881end
5882@end smallexample
5883
5884@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
5885@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
5886Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
5887This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
5888In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
5889special arguments are supported:
5890
5891@table @code
5892@item $regs
5893collect all registers
5894
5895@item $args
5896collect all function arguments
5897
5898@item $locals
5899collect all local variables.
5900@end table
5901
5902You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
5903with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
5904arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
5905
f5c37c66
EZ
5906The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
5907particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
5908
b37052ae
EZ
5909@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
5910@item while-stepping @var{n}
5911Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
5912new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
5913followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
5914its own @code{end} command):
5915
5916@smallexample
5917> while-stepping 12
5918 > collect $regs, myglobal
5919 > end
5920>
5921@end smallexample
5922
5923@noindent
5924You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
5925@code{stepping}.
5926@end table
5927
5928@node Listing Tracepoints
5929@subsection Listing Tracepoints
5930
5931@table @code
5932@kindex info tracepoints
5933@cindex information about tracepoints
5934@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5935Display information the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify a
5936tracepoint number displays information about all the tracepoints
5937defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
5938shown:
5939
5940@itemize @bullet
5941@item
5942its number
5943@item
5944whether it is enabled or disabled
5945@item
5946its address
5947@item
5948its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
5949@item
5950its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
5951@item
5952where in the source files is the tracepoint set
5953@item
5954its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
5955@end itemize
5956
5957@smallexample
5958(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
5959Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
59601 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
59612 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in gdb_test at gdb_test.c:375
59623 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in collect_data at ../foo.c:1741
5963(@value{GDBP})
5964@end smallexample
5965
5966@noindent
5967This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
5968@end table
5969
5970@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5971@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
5972
5973@table @code
5974@kindex tstart
5975@cindex start a new trace experiment
5976@cindex collected data discarded
5977@item tstart
5978This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
5979begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
5980the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
5981experiment.
5982
5983@kindex tstop
5984@cindex stop a running trace experiment
5985@item tstop
5986This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
5987stops collecting data.
5988
5989@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
5990automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
5991(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
5992
5993@kindex tstatus
5994@cindex status of trace data collection
5995@cindex trace experiment, status of
5996@item tstatus
5997This command displays the status of the current trace data
5998collection.
5999@end table
6000
6001Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6002
6003@smallexample
6004(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6005(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6006Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6007> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6008> while-stepping 11
6009 > collect $regs
6010 > end
6011> end
6012(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6013 [time passes @dots{}]
6014(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6015@end smallexample
6016
6017
6018@node Analyze Collected Data
6019@section Using the collected data
6020
6021After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6022for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6023collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6024snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6025consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6026examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6027specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6028snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6029registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6030rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6031debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6032(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6033behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6034when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6035the buffer will fail.
6036
6037@menu
6038* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6039* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6040* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6041@end menu
6042
6043@node tfind
6044@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6045
6046@kindex tfind
6047@cindex select trace snapshot
6048@cindex find trace snapshot
6049The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6050@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6051counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6052snapshot is selected.
6053
6054Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6055
6056@table @code
6057@item tfind start
6058Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6059@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6060
6061@item tfind none
6062Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6063
6064@item tfind end
6065Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6066
6067@item tfind
6068No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6069
6070@item tfind -
6071Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6072retracing earlier steps.
6073
6074@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6075Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6076proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6077argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6078for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6079
6080@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6081Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6082program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6083snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6084snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6085
6086@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6087Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6088addresses.
6089
6090@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6091Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6092@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6093
6094@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6095Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6096the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6097that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6098trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6099next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6100@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6101stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6102@end table
6103
6104The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6105designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6106instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6107snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6108trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6109simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6110snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6111@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6112The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6113for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6114no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6115(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6116no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6117tracepoint as the current one.
6118
6119In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6120these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6121scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6122you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6123registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6124
6125@smallexample
6126(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6127(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6128> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6129 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6130> tfind
6131> end
6132
6133Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6134Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6135Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6136Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6137Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6138Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6139Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6140Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6141Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6142Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6143Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6144@end smallexample
6145
6146Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6147the buffer:
6148
6149@smallexample
6150(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6151(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6152> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6153> tfind line
6154> end
6155
6156Frame 0, X = 1
6157Frame 7, X = 2
6158Frame 13, X = 255
6159@end smallexample
6160
6161@node tdump
6162@subsection @code{tdump}
6163@kindex tdump
6164@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6165@cindex tracepoint data, display
6166
6167This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6168the current trace snapshot.
6169
6170@smallexample
6171(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6172(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6173Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6174> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6175> end
6176
6177(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6178
6179(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6180#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6181at gdb_test.c:444
6182444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6183
6184(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6185Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6186d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6187d1 0x18 24
6188d2 0x80 128
6189d3 0x33 51
6190d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6191d5 0x22 34
6192d6 0xe0 224
6193d7 0x380035 3670069
6194a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6195a1 0x3000668 50333288
6196a2 0x100 256
6197a3 0x322000 3284992
6198a4 0x3000698 50333336
6199a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6200fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6201sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6202ps 0x0 0
6203pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6204fpcontrol 0x0 0
6205fpstatus 0x0 0
6206fpiaddr 0x0 0
6207p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6208p1 = (void *) 0x11
6209p2 = (void *) 0x22
6210p3 = (void *) 0x33
6211p4 = (void *) 0x44
6212p5 = (void *) 0x55
6213p6 = (void *) 0x66
6214gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6215
6216(@value{GDBP})
6217@end smallexample
6218
6219@node save-tracepoints
6220@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6221@kindex save-tracepoints
6222@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6223
6224This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6225their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6226suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6227tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6228Files}).
6229
6230@node Tracepoint Variables
6231@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6232@cindex tracepoint variables
6233@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6234
6235@table @code
6236@vindex $trace_frame
6237@item (int) $trace_frame
6238The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6239snapshot is selected.
6240
6241@vindex $tracepoint
6242@item (int) $tracepoint
6243The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6244
6245@vindex $trace_line
6246@item (int) $trace_line
6247The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6248
6249@vindex $trace_file
6250@item (char []) $trace_file
6251The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6252
6253@vindex $trace_func
6254@item (char []) $trace_func
6255The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6256@end table
6257
6258Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6259use @code{output} instead.
6260
6261Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6262stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6263data.
6264
6265@smallexample
6266(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6267
6268(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6269> output $trace_file
6270> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6271> tfind
6272> end
6273@end smallexample
6274
6d2ebf8b 6275@node Languages
c906108c
SS
6276@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
6277@cindex languages
6278
c906108c
SS
6279Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
6280rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
6281dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
6282Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 6283represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 6284@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
6285
6286@cindex working language
6287Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
6288allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
6289native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
6290consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
6291language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
6292language}.
6293
6294@menu
6295* Setting:: Switching between source languages
6296* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 6297* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
6298* Support:: Supported languages
6299@end menu
6300
6d2ebf8b 6301@node Setting
c906108c
SS
6302@section Switching between source languages
6303
6304There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
6305set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
6306@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
6307defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
6308used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
6309are printed, etc.
6310
6311In addition to the working language, every source file that
6312@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
6313file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
6314source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
6315language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 6316controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 6317show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
6318set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
6319set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
6320Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
6321
6322This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 6323as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
6324another language. In that case, make the
6325program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
6326@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
6327program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
6328
6329@menu
6330* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
6331* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
6332* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6333@end menu
6334
6d2ebf8b 6335@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
6336@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
6337
6338If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
6339@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
6340
6341@table @file
6342
6343@item .c
6344C source file
6345
6346@item .C
6347@itemx .cc
6348@itemx .cp
6349@itemx .cpp
6350@itemx .cxx
6351@itemx .c++
b37052ae 6352C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
6353
6354@item .f
6355@itemx .F
6356Fortran source file
6357
c906108c
SS
6358@item .ch
6359@itemx .c186
6360@itemx .c286
96a2c332 6361CHILL source file
c906108c 6362
c906108c
SS
6363@item .mod
6364Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
6365
6366@item .s
6367@itemx .S
6368Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
6369@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
6370@end table
6371
6372In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
6373extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
6374
6d2ebf8b 6375@node Manually
c906108c
SS
6376@subsection Setting the working language
6377
6378If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
6379expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
6380your program.
6381
6382@kindex set language
6383If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
6384command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 6385a language, such as
c906108c 6386@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
6387For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
6388
c906108c
SS
6389Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
6390language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
6391to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
6392source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
6393languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
6394source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
6395command such as:
6396
6397@example
6398print a = b + c
6399@end example
6400
6401@noindent
6402might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
6403@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
6404printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
6405@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 6406
6d2ebf8b 6407@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
6408@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6409
6410To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
6411@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
6412then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
6413frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
6414working language to the language recorded for the function in that
6415frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
6416or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
6417does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
6418not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
6419
6420This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
6421entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
6422written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
6423a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
6424case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
6425
6d2ebf8b 6426@node Show
c906108c 6427@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
6428
6429The following commands help you find out which language is the
6430working language, and also what language source files were written in.
6431
6432@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
6433@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
6434@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
6435@table @code
6436@item show language
6437Display the current working language. This is the
6438language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
6439build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
6440
6441@item info frame
5d161b24 6442Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 6443working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 6444@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6445information listed here.
6446
6447@item info source
6448Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 6449@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6450information listed here.
6451@end table
6452
6453In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
6454not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
6455with a language explicitly:
6456
6457@kindex set extension-language
6458@kindex info extensions
6459@table @code
6460@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
6461Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
6462the source language @var{language}.
6463
6464@item info extensions
6465List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
6466@end table
6467
6d2ebf8b 6468@node Checks
c906108c
SS
6469@section Type and range checking
6470
6471@quotation
6472@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
6473checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
6474section documents the intended facilities.
6475@end quotation
6476@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
6477
6478Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
6479errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
6480checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
6481sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
6482these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
6483by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
6484errors when your program is running.
6485
6486@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
6487Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
6488can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
6489the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
6490@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
6491your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
6492for the default settings of supported languages.
6493
6494@menu
6495* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
6496* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
6497@end menu
6498
6499@cindex type checking
6500@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 6501@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
6502@subsection An overview of type checking
6503
6504Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
6505arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
6506otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
6507errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
6508
6509@smallexample
65101 + 2 @result{} 3
6511@exdent but
6512@error{} 1 + 2.3
6513@end smallexample
6514
6515The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
6516type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
6517
5d161b24
DB
6518For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
6519@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
6520to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
6521or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
6522but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
6523these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
6524also issues a warning.
6525
5d161b24
DB
6526Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
6527related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
6528For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
6529a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
6530with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
6531the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
6532
6533Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
6534instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
6535operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
6536represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
6537operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
6538details on specific languages.
6539
6540@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
6541
d4f3574e 6542@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
6543@kindex set check type
6544@kindex show check type
6545@table @code
6546@item set check type auto
6547Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
6548@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6549each language.
6550
6551@item set check type on
6552@itemx set check type off
6553Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6554current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
6555match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 6556evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
6557message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
6558
6559@item set check type warn
6560Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
6561evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
6562be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
6563numbers and structures.
6564
6565@item show type
5d161b24 6566Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6567is setting it automatically.
6568@end table
6569
6570@cindex range checking
6571@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 6572@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
6573@subsection An overview of range checking
6574
6575In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
6576bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
6577checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
6578computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
6579not exceed the bounds of the array.
6580
6581For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
6582@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
6583always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
6584warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
6585
6586A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
6587array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
6588of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
6589error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
6590result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
6591the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
6592
6593@example
6594@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
6595@end example
6596
6597This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
6598specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
6599Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
6600
6601@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
6602
d4f3574e 6603@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
6604@kindex set check range
6605@kindex show check range
6606@table @code
6607@item set check range auto
6608Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
6609@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6610each language.
6611
6612@item set check range on
6613@itemx set check range off
6614Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6615current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
6616match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
6617then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
6618
6619@item set check range warn
6620Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
6621but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
6622expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
6623memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
6624systems).
6625
6626@item show range
6627Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
6628being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
6629@end table
c906108c 6630
6d2ebf8b 6631@node Support
c906108c 6632@section Supported languages
c906108c 6633
b37052ae 6634@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 6635@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
6636Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
6637language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
6638and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
6639,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
6640language.
6641
6642The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
6643supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
6644tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
6645@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
6646formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
6647books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
6648language reference or tutorial.
6649
c906108c 6650@menu
b37052ae 6651* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 6652* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 6653* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
6654@end menu
6655
6d2ebf8b 6656@node C
b37052ae 6657@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 6658
b37052ae
EZ
6659@cindex C and C@t{++}
6660@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 6661
b37052ae 6662Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
6663to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
6664together.
6665
41afff9a
EZ
6666@cindex C@t{++}
6667@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
6668@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
6669The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
6670compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
6671effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
6672C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6673compiler (@code{aCC}).
6674
b37052ae 6675For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
6676format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
6677command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
6678@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
6679CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 6680
c906108c 6681@menu
b37052ae
EZ
6682* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
6683* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
6684* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
6685* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
6686* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 6687* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 6688* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 6689@end menu
c906108c 6690
6d2ebf8b 6691@node C Operators
b37052ae 6692@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 6693
b37052ae 6694@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
6695
6696Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6697@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 6698often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 6699
b37052ae 6700For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
6701
6702@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 6703
c906108c 6704@item
c906108c 6705@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 6706specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
6707
6708@item
d4f3574e
SS
6709@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
6710@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
6711
6712@item
53a5351d 6713@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
6714
6715@item
6716@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 6717
c906108c
SS
6718@end itemize
6719
6720@noindent
6721The following operators are supported. They are listed here
6722in order of increasing precedence:
6723
6724@table @code
6725@item ,
6726The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
6727are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
6728expression being the last expression evaluated.
6729
6730@item =
6731Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
6732assigned. Defined on scalar types.
6733
6734@item @var{op}=
6735Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
6736and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 6737@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
6738@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
6739@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
6740
6741@item ?:
6742The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
6743of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
6744integral type.
6745
6746@item ||
6747Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6748
6749@item &&
6750Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6751
6752@item |
6753Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6754
6755@item ^
6756Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6757
6758@item &
6759Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6760
6761@item ==@r{, }!=
6762Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
6763expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
6764
6765@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
6766Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
6767Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
6768and non-zero for true.
6769
6770@item <<@r{, }>>
6771left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
6772
6773@item @@
6774The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6775
6776@item +@r{, }-
6777Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
6778pointer types.
6779
6780@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
6781Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
6782defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
6783integral types.
6784
6785@item ++@r{, }--
6786Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
6787operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
6788when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
6789operation takes place.
6790
6791@item *
6792Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
6793@code{++}.
6794
6795@item &
6796Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
6797
b37052ae
EZ
6798For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
6799allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 6800(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 6801where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 6802stored.
c906108c
SS
6803
6804@item -
6805Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
6806precedence as @code{++}.
6807
6808@item !
6809Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6810@code{++}.
6811
6812@item ~
6813Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6814@code{++}.
6815
6816
6817@item .@r{, }->
6818Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
6819@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
6820pointer based on the stored type information.
6821Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
6822
c906108c
SS
6823@item .*@r{, }->*
6824Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
6825
6826@item []
6827Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
6828@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6829
6830@item ()
6831Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6832
c906108c 6833@item ::
b37052ae 6834C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 6835and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
6836
6837@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
6838Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
6839(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
6840above.
c906108c
SS
6841@end table
6842
c906108c
SS
6843If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
6844attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
6845predefined meaning.
c906108c 6846
c906108c 6847@menu
5d161b24 6848* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
6849@end menu
6850
6d2ebf8b 6851@node C Constants
b37052ae 6852@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 6853
b37052ae 6854@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 6855
b37052ae 6856@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 6857following ways:
c906108c
SS
6858
6859@itemize @bullet
6860@item
6861Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6862specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6863a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
6864@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6865@code{long} value.
6866
6867@item
6868Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6869point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6870exponent. An exponent is of the form:
6871@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6872sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
6873A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6874@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6875the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6876a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6877constant.
c906108c
SS
6878
6879@item
6880Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6881integral equivalents.
6882
6883@item
6884Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6885(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 6886(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
6887be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6888the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6889of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6890@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6891@samp{\n} for newline.
6892
6893@item
96a2c332
SS
6894String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6895double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
6896above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6897a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6898characters.
c906108c
SS
6899
6900@item
6901Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
6902to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6903
6904@item
6905Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6906and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6907integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6908and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6909@end itemize
6910
c906108c 6911@menu
5d161b24
DB
6912* C plus plus expressions::
6913* C Defaults::
6914* C Checks::
c906108c 6915
5d161b24 6916* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
6917@end menu
6918
6d2ebf8b 6919@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
6920@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
6921
6922@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
6923@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
6924
6925@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
6926@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
6927@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
6928@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
6929@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
6930@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
6931@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
6932@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
6933@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6934@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6935@c periodically whether this has happened...
6936@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
6937@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
6938proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
6939additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6940special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6941@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6942symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6943you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6944extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 6945@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6946support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6947@end quotation
c906108c
SS
6948
6949@enumerate
6950
6951@cindex member functions
6952@item
6953Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6954
6955@example
6956count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6957@end example
6958
41afff9a 6959@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 6960@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6961@item
6962While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6963expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6964that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 6965pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 6966
c906108c 6967@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 6968@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 6969@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
6970@item
6971You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 6972call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
6973perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6974calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6975in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6976default arguments.
6977
6978It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6979promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6980class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6981functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6982number of function arguments.
6983
6984Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6985@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 6986,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 6987
d4f3574e 6988You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
6989explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6990@smallexample
6991p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6992@end smallexample
d4f3574e 6993
c906108c 6994The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 6995see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 6996
c906108c
SS
6997@cindex reference declarations
6998@item
b37052ae
EZ
6999@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
7000them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
7001dereferenced.
7002
7003In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
7004reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
7005avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
7006The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
7007you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
7008
7009@item
b37052ae 7010@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
7011expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
7012one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
7013necessary, for example in an expression like
7014@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 7015resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7016debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
7017@end enumerate
7018
b37052ae 7019In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
7020calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
7021objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
7022invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 7023
6d2ebf8b 7024@node C Defaults
b37052ae 7025@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 7026
b37052ae 7027@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 7028
c906108c
SS
7029If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
7030both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 7031C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 7032selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
7033
7034If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
7035recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
7036@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 7037these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
7038@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
7039for further details.
7040
c906108c
SS
7041@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
7042@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
7043@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 7044
6d2ebf8b 7045@node C Checks
b37052ae 7046@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 7047
b37052ae 7048@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 7049
b37052ae 7050By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
7051is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
7052considers two variables type equivalent if:
7053
7054@itemize @bullet
7055@item
7056The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
7057enumerated tag.
7058
7059@item
7060The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
7061declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
7062
7063@ignore
7064@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
7065@c FIXME--beers?
7066@item
7067The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
7068declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
7069compilers.)
7070@end ignore
7071@end itemize
7072
7073Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
7074indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
7075that is not itself an array.
c906108c 7076
6d2ebf8b 7077@node Debugging C
c906108c 7078@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
7079
7080The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
7081the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
7082inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
7083appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
7084
7085The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
7086with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
7087,Expressions}.
7088
c906108c 7089@menu
5d161b24 7090* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
7091@end menu
7092
6d2ebf8b 7093@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 7094@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7095
b37052ae 7096@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7097
b37052ae
EZ
7098Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
7099designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
7100
7101@table @code
7102@cindex break in overloaded functions
7103@item @r{breakpoint menus}
7104When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
7105@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
7106you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
7107
b37052ae 7108@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7109@item rbreak @var{regex}
7110Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
7111breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
7112classes.
7113@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
7114
b37052ae 7115@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
7116@item catch throw
7117@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 7118Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
7119Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
7120
7121@cindex inheritance
7122@item ptype @var{typename}
7123Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
7124@var{typename}.
7125@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
7126
b37052ae 7127@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
7128@item set print demangle
7129@itemx show print demangle
7130@itemx set print asm-demangle
7131@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
7132Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
7133displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
7134@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7135
7136@item set print object
7137@itemx show print object
7138Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
7139@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7140
7141@item set print vtbl
7142@itemx show print vtbl
7143Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
7144@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 7145(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 7146ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
7147
7148@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 7149@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 7150@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 7151Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
7152is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
7153and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 7154using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 7155expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
7156message.
7157
7158@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 7159Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
7160overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7161chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
7162symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
7163overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7164searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
7165argument types.
c906108c
SS
7166
7167@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
7168You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 7169the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
7170@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
7171also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
7172available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
7173@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
7174@end table
c906108c 7175
6d2ebf8b 7176@node Modula-2
c906108c 7177@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 7178
d4f3574e 7179@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
7180
7181The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
7182output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
7183developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
7184attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
7185to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7186table.
7187
7188@cindex expressions in Modula-2
7189@menu
7190* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
7191* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
7192* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
7193* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
7194* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
7195* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
7196* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7197* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7198@end menu
7199
6d2ebf8b 7200@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
7201@subsubsection Operators
7202@cindex Modula-2 operators
7203
7204Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7205@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7206often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
7207following definitions hold:
7208
7209@itemize @bullet
7210
7211@item
7212@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
7213their subranges.
7214
7215@item
7216@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
7217
7218@item
7219@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
7220
7221@item
7222@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
7223@var{type}}.
7224
7225@item
7226@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
7227
7228@item
7229@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
7230
7231@item
7232@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
7233@end itemize
7234
7235@noindent
7236The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
7237increasing precedence:
7238
7239@table @code
7240@item ,
7241Function argument or array index separator.
7242
7243@item :=
7244Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
7245@var{value}.
7246
7247@item <@r{, }>
7248Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
7249types.
7250
7251@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 7252Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
7253on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
7254set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
7255
7256@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
7257Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
7258Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
7259available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
7260comment character.
7261
7262@item IN
7263Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
7264Same precedence as @code{<}.
7265
7266@item OR
7267Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
7268
7269@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 7270Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
7271
7272@item @@
7273The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7274
7275@item +@r{, }-
7276Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
7277and difference on set types.
7278
7279@item *
7280Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
7281on set types.
7282
7283@item /
7284Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
7285types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
7286
7287@item DIV@r{, }MOD
7288Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
7289precedence as @code{*}.
7290
7291@item -
7292Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
7293
7294@item ^
7295Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
7296
7297@item NOT
7298Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
7299@code{^}.
7300
7301@item .
7302@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
7303precedence as @code{^}.
7304
7305@item []
7306Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
7307
7308@item ()
7309Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
7310as @code{^}.
7311
7312@item ::@r{, }.
7313@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
7314@end table
7315
7316@quotation
7317@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
7318treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
7319@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
7320@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
7321@end quotation
7322
cb51c4e0 7323
6d2ebf8b 7324@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 7325@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 7326@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
7327
7328Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
7329In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
7330
7331@table @var
7332
7333@item a
7334represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
7335
7336@item c
7337represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
7338
7339@item i
7340represents a variable or constant of integral type.
7341
7342@item m
7343represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
7344same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
7345be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
7346
7347@item n
7348represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
7349
7350@item r
7351represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
7352
7353@item t
7354represents a type.
7355
7356@item v
7357represents a variable.
7358
7359@item x
7360represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
7361explanation of the function for details.
7362@end table
7363
7364All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
7365
7366@table @code
7367@item ABS(@var{n})
7368Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
7369
7370@item CAP(@var{c})
7371If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 7372equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
7373
7374@item CHR(@var{i})
7375Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7376
7377@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7378Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7379
7380@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
7381Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7382new value.
7383
7384@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7385Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
7386set.
7387
7388@item FLOAT(@var{i})
7389Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
7390
7391@item HIGH(@var{a})
7392Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
7393
7394@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7395Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7396
7397@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
7398Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7399new value.
7400
7401@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7402Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
7403there. Returns the new set.
7404
7405@item MAX(@var{t})
7406Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
7407
7408@item MIN(@var{t})
7409Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
7410
7411@item ODD(@var{i})
7412Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
7413
7414@item ORD(@var{x})
7415Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
7416value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
7417@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
7418integral, character and enumerated types.
7419
7420@item SIZE(@var{x})
7421Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
7422
7423@item TRUNC(@var{r})
7424Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
7425
7426@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
7427Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7428@end table
7429
7430@quotation
7431@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
7432@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
7433an error.
7434@end quotation
7435
7436@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 7437@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
7438@subsubsection Constants
7439
7440@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
7441ways:
7442
7443@itemize @bullet
7444
7445@item
7446Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
7447expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
7448rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
7449trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
7450
7451@item
7452Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
7453decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
7454then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
7455@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
7456digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
7457digits.
7458
7459@item
7460Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
7461like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 7462also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
7463followed by a @samp{C}.
7464
7465@item
7466String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
7467pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
7468Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 7469Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
7470sequences.
7471
7472@item
7473Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
7474
7475@item
7476Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
7477@code{FALSE}.
7478
7479@item
7480Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
7481
7482@item
7483Set constants are not yet supported.
7484@end itemize
7485
6d2ebf8b 7486@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
7487@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
7488@cindex Modula-2 defaults
7489
7490If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7491both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7492Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7493selected the working language.
7494
7495If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7496code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 7497working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
7498the language automatically}, for further details.
7499
6d2ebf8b 7500@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
7501@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
7502@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
7503
7504A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
7505This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
7506
7507@itemize @bullet
7508@item
7509Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
7510integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
7511debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
7512pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
7513through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
7514returned a pointer.)
7515
7516@item
7517C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
7518non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
7519escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
7520printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
7521
7522@item
7523The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
7524argument.
7525
7526@item
7527All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
7528@end itemize
7529
6d2ebf8b 7530@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
7531@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
7532@cindex Modula-2 checks
7533
7534@quotation
7535@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
7536range checking.
7537@end quotation
7538@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
7539
7540@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
7541
7542@itemize @bullet
7543@item
7544They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
7545@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
7546
7547@item
7548They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
7549@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
7550@end itemize
7551
7552As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
7553whose types are not equivalent is an error.
7554
7555Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7556index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
7557
6d2ebf8b 7558@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
7559@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7560@cindex scope
41afff9a 7561@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
7562@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
7563@ifinfo
41afff9a 7564@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
7565@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
7566@end ifinfo
7567@iftex
41afff9a 7568@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
7569@end iftex
7570
7571There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
7572(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
7573similar syntax:
7574
7575@example
7576
7577@var{module} . @var{id}
7578@var{scope} :: @var{id}
7579@end example
7580
7581@noindent
7582where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
7583@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
7584identifier within your program, except another module.
7585
7586Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
7587specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
7588found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
7589enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
7590
7591Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
7592the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
7593definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
7594an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
7595module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
7596@var{module}.
7597
6d2ebf8b 7598@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
7599@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7600
7601Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
7602Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 7603specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 7604@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 7605apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
7606analogue in Modula-2.
7607
7608The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 7609with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 7610intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 7611created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 7612address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 7613@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
7614
7615@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
7616In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
7617interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 7618
6d2ebf8b 7619@node Chill
cce74817
JM
7620@subsection Chill
7621
7622The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 7623from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
7624supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
7625likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7626table.
7627
d4f3574e
SS
7628@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
7629@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
7630This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
7631of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
7632
7633@menu
104c1213
JM
7634* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
7635* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 7636* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
5d161b24 7637* Chill type and range checks::
53a5351d 7638* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
7639@end menu
7640
6d2ebf8b 7641@node How modes are displayed
cce74817
JM
7642@subsubsection How modes are displayed
7643
7644The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 7645with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
7646slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
7647provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
7648
7649@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
7650@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
7651@table @code
7652@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
7653@itemize @bullet
7654@item
7655@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
7656UINT, LONG, ULONG},
7657@item
5d161b24 7658@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
cce74817 7659@item
5d161b24 7660@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
cce74817
JM
7661@item
7662@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
7663@smallexample
7664(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7665type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7666@end smallexample
7667If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
7668@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7669@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
7670@smallexample
7671@code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
7672@end smallexample
7673where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
7674expression (e.g. set element names).
cce74817
JM
7675@end itemize
7676
7677@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
7678A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 7679the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
7680@smallexample
7681(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7682type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
7683@end smallexample
7684
7685@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
7686@itemize @bullet
7687@item
d4f3574e 7688@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
7689followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
7690@item
7691@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
7692@end itemize
7693
7694@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
7695The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
7696<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
7697list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
7698the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
7699all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
7700
7701@ignore
7702@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
7703The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
5d161b24 7704type, and is therefore not really of interest.
cce74817
JM
7705@end ignore
7706
5d161b24 7707@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7708@itemize @bullet
7709@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7710@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
7711@smallexample
7712@code{EVENT (<event length>)}
7713@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7714where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
7715@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7716@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
7717@smallexample
7718@code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
7719@end smallexample
7720where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
cce74817
JM
7721@end itemize
7722
5d161b24 7723@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
7724@itemize @bullet
7725@item
7726@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
7727@item
7728@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
7729@end itemize
7730
7731@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
7732Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
7733
7734@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
7735@itemize @bullet
7736@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7737@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
7738@smallexample
7739@code{CHARS(<string length>)}
7740@end smallexample
7741followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
7742mode
cce74817 7743@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
7744@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
7745@smallexample
7746@code{BOOLS(<string
7747length>)}
7748@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
7749@end itemize
7750
7751@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
7752The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
7753followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
7754@smallexample
7755(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
5d161b24
DB
7756type = ARRAY (1:42)
7757 ARRAY (1:20)
cce74817
JM
7758 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7759@end smallexample
7760
5d161b24 7761@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
cce74817 7762The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
7763list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
7764of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
7765OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
7766of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
7767checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
7768always displays all variant fields.
7769@smallexample
7770(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
7771type = STRUCT (
7772 as x,
7773 bs x,
7774 CASE bs OF
7775 (karli):
7776 cs a
7777 (ott):
7778 ds x
7779 ESAC
7780)
7781@end smallexample
7782@end table
7783
6d2ebf8b 7784@node Locations
cce74817
JM
7785@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
7786
7787A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
7788
7789A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
7790the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
7791Chill programs. How values are specified
7792is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7793
7794The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
7795display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 7796
cce74817
JM
7797@smallexample
7798set result := EXPR
7799@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
7800
7801@noindent
7802This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 7803is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
7804
7805Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
7806value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 7807mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
7808represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
7809value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 7810operator @samp{->}.
cce74817 7811
6d2ebf8b
SS
7812Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
7813@smallexample
7814@code{@{ PROC
cce74817 7815(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
6d2ebf8b
SS
7816location>}
7817@end smallexample
7818@code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
7819specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
7820the entry point.
cce74817
JM
7821
7822@ignore
7823Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
7824fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
7825the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
7826implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
7827na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
7828<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
7829@code{__proc_copy}.
7830
7831Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
7832the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
7833like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
7834mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
7835
7836Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 7837...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 7838definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
7839of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
7840structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
7841braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 7842on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 7843memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 7844all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 7845@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
7846stuff ???)
7847@smallexample
7848(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
7849[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
7850@end smallexample
7851@end ignore
7852
7853Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
7854(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
7855certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
7856and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
7857
7858A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
7859location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
7860name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
7861have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
7862checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 7863therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 7864
cce74817
JM
7865@smallexample
7866(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
7867@end smallexample
7868
6d2ebf8b 7869@node Values and their Operations
cce74817
JM
7870@subsubsection Values and their Operations
7871
7872Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7873more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
7874data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7875such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 7876constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 7877when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
7878(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7879the values behind these locations.
7880
d4f3574e 7881This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
7882operations are legal to be used with such values.
7883
7884@table @code
7885@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
7886Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7887For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 7888chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
7889@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7890@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817 7891
5d161b24 7892@ignore
cce74817
JM
7893@itemize @bullet
7894@item
7895@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 7896programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
7897@item
7898@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7899@item
7900@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7901@code{'M'})
7902@item
7903@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e 7904mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
b37052ae 7905comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
cce74817 7906@item
d4f3574e 7907@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817 7908emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
5d161b24 7909procedure value or the empty instance value.
cce74817
JM
7910
7911@item
7912@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 7913enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
7914to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7915@item
7916@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7917programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7918@item
7919@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 7920(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
7921@end itemize
7922@end ignore
7923
7924@item Tuple Values
7925A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 7926name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
7927unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7928@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 7929
cce74817
JM
7930@itemize @bullet
7931@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7932@item @emph{Array Tuple}
7933@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7934Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 7935same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
7936@end itemize
7937
7938@item String Element Value
6d2ebf8b
SS
7939A string element value is specified by
7940@smallexample
7941@code{<string value>(<index>)}
7942@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7943where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
7944value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7945the string.
7946
7947@item String Slice Value
7948A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7949spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7950expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7951@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7952The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7953string.
7954
7955@item Array Element Values
7956An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7957delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7958
7959@item Array Slice Values
7960An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7961@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
7962@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7963arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
7964which is part of the specified array.
7965
7966@item Structure Field Values
7967A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
7968name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7969in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
7970corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7971
7972@item Procedure Call Value
7973The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7974procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7975expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 7976effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 7977
d4f3574e 7978Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 7979
6d2ebf8b
SS
7980Values of time mode locations appear as
7981@smallexample
7982@code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
7983@end smallexample
7984
cce74817
JM
7985
7986@ignore
7987This is not implemented yet:
7988@item Built-in Value
7989@noindent
7990The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 7991
cce74817
JM
7992@table @code
7993@item @code{ADDR()}
7994@item @code{NUM()}
7995@item @code{PRED()}
7996@item @code{SUCC()}
7997@item @code{ABS()}
7998@item @code{CARD()}
7999@item @code{MAX()}
8000@item @code{MIN()}
8001@item @code{SIZE()}
8002@item @code{UPPER()}
8003@item @code{LOWER()}
8004@item @code{LENGTH()}
8005@item @code{SIN()}
8006@item @code{COS()}
8007@item @code{TAN()}
8008@item @code{ARCSIN()}
8009@item @code{ARCCOS()}
8010@item @code{ARCTAN()}
8011@item @code{EXP()}
8012@item @code{LN()}
8013@item @code{LOG()}
8014@item @code{SQRT()}
8015@end table
8016
8017For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
8018chapter 1.6.
8019@end ignore
8020
8021@item Zero-adic Operator Value
8022The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
8023current active process.
8024
8025@item Expression Values
8026The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 8027the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 8028incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 8029corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 8030causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 8031which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 8032operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 8033
cce74817
JM
8034@table @code
8035@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8036@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
8037@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8038Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 8039
cce74817
JM
8040@item @code{=, /=}
8041Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 8042
cce74817 8043@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8044@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8045Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8046
cce74817 8047@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 8048@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 8049Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8050
cce74817
JM
8051@item @code{-}
8052Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 8053
cce74817
JM
8054@item @code{//}
8055String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 8056
cce74817
JM
8057@item @code{()}
8058String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 8059
cce74817
JM
8060@item @code{->}
8061Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
8062address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
8063location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 8064
cce74817 8065@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8066@itemx @code{AND}
8067@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8068Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 8069
cce74817 8070@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8071@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8072Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 8073
cce74817
JM
8074@item @code{IN}
8075Membership operator.
8076@end table
8077@end table
8078
6d2ebf8b 8079@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
8080@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
8081
8082@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 8083of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 8084complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 8085equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
8086structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
8087
8088Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8089index bounds and all built in procedures.
8090
8091Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 8092check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
8093operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
8094functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
8095language specification.
8096
cce74817
JM
8097All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
8098off}.
8099
5d161b24 8100@ignore
53a5351d 8101@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
8102see last paragraph ?
8103@end ignore
8104
6d2ebf8b 8105@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
8106@subsubsection Chill defaults
8107
8108If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8109both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8110Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
8111selected the working language.
8112
8113If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8114code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 8115working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
8116the language automatically}, for further details.
8117
6d2ebf8b 8118@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8119@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8120
d4f3574e 8121The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8122symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8123program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8124does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8125program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8126(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8127file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8128
8129@cindex symbol names
8130@cindex names of symbols
8131@cindex quoting names
8132Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8133characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8134most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8135source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8136are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8137ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8138@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8139@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8140
8141@example
8142p 'foo.c'::x
8143@end example
8144
8145@noindent
8146looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8147
8148@table @code
8149@kindex info address
b37052ae 8150@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8151@item info address @var{symbol}
8152Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8153variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8154local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8155is always stored.
8156
8157Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8158at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8159the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8160
3d67e040 8161@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8162@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8163@item info symbol @var{addr}
8164Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8165If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8166nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8167
8168@example
8169(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8170_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8171@end example
8172
8173@noindent
8174This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8175it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8176
c906108c 8177@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8178@item whatis @var{expr}
8179Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8180actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8181assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8182@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8183
8184@item whatis
8185Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8186
8187@kindex ptype
8188@item ptype @var{typename}
8189Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8190the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8191@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8192@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8193
d4f3574e 8194@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8195@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8196Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8197differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8198of just the name of the type.
8199
8200For example, for this variable declaration:
8201
8202@example
8203struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8204@end example
8205
8206@noindent
8207the two commands give this output:
8208
8209@example
8210@group
8211(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8212type = struct complex
8213(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8214type = struct complex @{
8215 double real;
8216 double imag;
8217@}
8218@end group
8219@end example
8220
8221@noindent
8222As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8223the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8224
8225@kindex info types
8226@item info types @var{regexp}
8227@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8228Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8229(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8230complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8231@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8232names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8233information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8234
8235This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8236@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8237lists all source files where a type is defined.
8238
b37052ae
EZ
8239@kindex info scope
8240@cindex local variables
8241@item info scope @var{addr}
8242List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8243accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8244preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8245scope defined by that location. For example:
8246
8247@smallexample
8248(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8249Scope for command_line_handler:
8250Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8251Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8252Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8253Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8254Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8255Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8256Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8257@end smallexample
8258
f5c37c66
EZ
8259@noindent
8260This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8261during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8262collect}.
8263
c906108c
SS
8264@kindex info source
8265@item info source
8266Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
8267the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
8268it was written in.
8269
8270@kindex info sources
8271@item info sources
8272Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8273debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8274have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8275
8276@kindex info functions
8277@item info functions
8278Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8279
8280@item info functions @var{regexp}
8281Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8282whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8283Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8284include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
8285start with @code{step}.
8286
8287@kindex info variables
8288@item info variables
8289Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
8290outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
8291
8292@item info variables @var{regexp}
8293Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8294variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8295@var{regexp}.
8296
8297@ignore
8298This was never implemented.
8299@kindex info methods
8300@item info methods
8301@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8302The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8303methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8304specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8305C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8306from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8307@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8308which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8309@end ignore
8310
c906108c
SS
8311@cindex reloading symbols
8312Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8313be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8314in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8315running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8316@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8317
8318@table @code
8319@kindex set symbol-reloading
8320@item set symbol-reloading on
8321Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8322object file with a particular name is seen again.
8323
8324@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8325Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8326same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8327running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8328should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8329may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8330several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8331name.
c906108c
SS
8332
8333@kindex show symbol-reloading
8334@item show symbol-reloading
8335Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8336@end table
c906108c 8337
c906108c
SS
8338@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8339@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8340Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8341declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8342@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8343source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8344another source file. The default is on.
8345
8346A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8347the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8348
8349@item set opaque-type-resolution off
8350Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8351is printed as follows:
8352@smallexample
8353@{<no data fields>@}
8354@end smallexample
8355
8356@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8357@item show opaque-type-resolution
8358Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
8359
8360@kindex maint print symbols
8361@cindex symbol dump
8362@kindex maint print psymbols
8363@cindex partial symbol dump
8364@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8365@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8366@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8367Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8368These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
8369symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
8370symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
8371collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
8372only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
8373command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
8374use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
8375symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
8376files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
8377@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
8378required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
8379@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
8380@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
8381@end table
8382
6d2ebf8b 8383@node Altering
c906108c
SS
8384@chapter Altering Execution
8385
8386Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
8387find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
8388correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
8389experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
8390program.
8391
8392For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
8393locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
8394address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
8395
8396@menu
8397* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
8398* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 8399* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
8400* Returning:: Returning from a function
8401* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
8402* Patching:: Patching your program
8403@end menu
8404
6d2ebf8b 8405@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
8406@section Assignment to variables
8407
8408@cindex assignment
8409@cindex setting variables
8410To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
8411@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
8412
8413@example
8414print x=4
8415@end example
8416
8417@noindent
8418stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 8419value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
8420@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
8421information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
8422
8423@kindex set variable
8424@cindex variables, setting
8425If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
8426@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
8427really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
8428not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
8429,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
8430
c906108c
SS
8431If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
8432appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
8433variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
8434to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
8435program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
8436a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
8437command @code{set width}:
8438
8439@example
8440(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
8441type = double
8442(@value{GDBP}) p width
8443$4 = 13
8444(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
8445Invalid syntax in expression.
8446@end example
8447
8448@noindent
8449The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
8450order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
8451
8452@example
8453(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
8454@end example
53a5351d 8455
c906108c
SS
8456Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
8457with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
8458@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
8459your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
8460to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
8461the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
8462
8463@example
8464@group
8465(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
8466type = double
8467(@value{GDBP}) p g
8468$1 = 1
8469(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 8470(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
8471$2 = 1
8472(@value{GDBP}) r
8473The program being debugged has been started already.
8474Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
8475Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
8476"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
8477 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
8478(@value{GDBP}) show g
8479The current BFD target is "=4".
8480@end group
8481@end example
8482
8483@noindent
8484The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
8485@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
8486@code{g}, use
8487
8488@example
8489(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
8490@end example
c906108c
SS
8491
8492@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
8493freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
8494and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
8495same length or shorter.
8496@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
8497@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
8498
8499To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
8500construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
8501(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
8502to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
8503and representation in memory), and
8504
8505@example
8506set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
8507@end example
8508
8509@noindent
8510stores the value 4 into that memory location.
8511
6d2ebf8b 8512@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
8513@section Continuing at a different address
8514
8515Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
8516it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
8517an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
8518
8519@table @code
8520@kindex jump
8521@item jump @var{linespec}
8522Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
8523immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
8524source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
8525@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
8526in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
8527breakpoints}.
8528
8529The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
8530the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
8531register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
8532a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
8533be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
8534of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
8535confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
8536executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
8537well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
8538
8539@item jump *@var{address}
8540Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
8541@end table
8542
c906108c 8543@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
8544On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
8545command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
8546difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
8547changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
8548example,
c906108c
SS
8549
8550@example
8551set $pc = 0x485
8552@end example
8553
8554@noindent
8555makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
8556address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
8557@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
8558
8559The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
8560up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
8561that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
8562detail.
8563
c906108c 8564@c @group
6d2ebf8b 8565@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
8566@section Giving your program a signal
8567
8568@table @code
8569@kindex signal
8570@item signal @var{signal}
8571Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
8572signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
8573signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
8574SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
8575
8576Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
8577giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
8578a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
8579@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
8580signal.
8581
8582@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
8583after executing the command.
8584@end table
8585@c @end group
8586
8587Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
8588@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
8589causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
8590the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
8591passes the signal directly to your program.
8592
c906108c 8593
6d2ebf8b 8594@node Returning
c906108c
SS
8595@section Returning from a function
8596
8597@table @code
8598@cindex returning from a function
8599@kindex return
8600@item return
8601@itemx return @var{expression}
8602You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
8603command. If you give an
8604@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
8605value.
8606@end table
8607
8608When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
8609(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
8610discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
8611be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
8612
8613This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
8614frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
8615innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
8616specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
8617of functions.
8618
8619The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
8620program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
8621returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
8622and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
8623selected stack frame returns naturally.
8624
6d2ebf8b 8625@node Calling
c906108c
SS
8626@section Calling program functions
8627
8628@cindex calling functions
8629@kindex call
8630@table @code
8631@item call @var{expr}
8632Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
8633returned values.
8634@end table
8635
8636You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
8637execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
8638with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
8639is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 8640
c906108c
SS
8641For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
8642specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
8643calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
8644method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
8645that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 8646
6d2ebf8b 8647@node Patching
c906108c 8648@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 8649
c906108c
SS
8650@cindex patching binaries
8651@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 8652@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 8653
7a292a7a
SS
8654By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
8655executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
8656alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
8657patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
8658
8659If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
8660explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
8661want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
8662repairs.
8663
8664@table @code
8665@kindex set write
8666@item set write on
8667@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
8668If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
8669core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
8670off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
8671
8672If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
8673@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
8674write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
8675
8676@item show write
8677@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
8678Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
8679as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
8680@end table
8681
6d2ebf8b 8682@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
8683@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
8684
7a292a7a
SS
8685@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
8686both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
8687program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
8688@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
8689
8690@menu
8691* Files:: Commands to specify files
8692* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
8693@end menu
8694
6d2ebf8b 8695@node Files
c906108c 8696@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 8697
7a292a7a 8698@cindex symbol table
c906108c 8699@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
8700
8701You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
8702way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
8703@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
8704Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
8705
8706Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
8707@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
8708a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
8709to specify new files are useful.
8710
8711@table @code
8712@cindex executable file
8713@kindex file
8714@item file @var{filename}
8715Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
8716symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
8717executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
8718directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
8719@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
8720directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
8721to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
8722and your program, using the @code{path} command.
8723
6d2ebf8b 8724On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
8725@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
8726@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
8727@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
8728descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
8729(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 8730@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 8731for more information.
c906108c
SS
8732
8733@item file
8734@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
8735has on both executable file and the symbol table.
8736
8737@kindex exec-file
8738@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8739Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
8740in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
8741if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
8742discard information on the executable file.
8743
8744@kindex symbol-file
8745@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8746Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
8747searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
8748table and program to run from the same file.
8749
8750@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
8751program's symbol table.
8752
5d161b24 8753The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
8754of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
8755auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
8756the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
8757the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
8758
8759@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
8760executing it once.
8761
8762When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
8763understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
8764generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
8765other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
8766Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
8767using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
8768optimized code.
c906108c
SS
8769
8770For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
8771using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
8772symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
8773quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
8774details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
8775
8776The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
8777start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
8778occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
8779file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
8780pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
8781warnings and messages}.)
8782
c906108c
SS
8783We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
8784symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
8785symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
8786still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
8787in stabs format.
8788
8789@kindex readnow
8790@cindex reading symbols immediately
8791@cindex symbols, reading immediately
8792@kindex mapped
8793@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
8794@cindex saving symbol table
8795@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8796@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8797You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
8798tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
8799load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 8800entire symbol table available.
c906108c 8801
c906108c
SS
8802If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
8803@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
8804cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
8805file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
8806from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
8807than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
8808program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
8809starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
8810
8811You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
8812file has all the symbol information for your program.
8813
8814The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
8815@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
8816than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
8817it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
8818needed.
8819
8820The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
8821@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
8822symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
8823
8824@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
8825@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
8826@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
8827@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
8828@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
8829@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
8830@c files.
8831
8832@kindex core
8833@kindex core-file
8834@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8835Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
8836of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
8837address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
8838executable file itself for other parts.
8839
8840@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
8841to be used.
8842
8843Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
8844under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
8845wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
8846the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 8847(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 8848
c906108c
SS
8849@kindex add-symbol-file
8850@cindex dynamic linking
8851@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
8852@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
d167840f 8853@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}
96a2c332
SS
8854The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
8855information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
8856when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
8857into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
8858address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
8859this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
8860of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
8861section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
8862@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
8863
8864The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
8865originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
8866@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
8867thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
8868instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c
SS
8869
8870@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8871
8872You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
8873the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
8874table information for @var{filename}.
8875
8876@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
8877@item add-shared-symbol-file
8878The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
8879operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
8880shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 8881@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 8882
c906108c
SS
8883@kindex section
8884@item section
5d161b24
DB
8885The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
8886the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
8887section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
8888specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
8889separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
8890the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
8891
8892@kindex info files
8893@kindex info target
8894@item info files
8895@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
8896@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
8897current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
8898including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
8899use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
8900command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
8901current ones.
8902
c906108c
SS
8903@end table
8904
8905All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
8906as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
8907name and remembers it that way.
8908
c906108c 8909@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
8910@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
8911libraries.
53a5351d 8912
c906108c
SS
8913@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
8914when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
8915(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
8916references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
8917debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
8918
8919On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8920automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8921
c906108c
SS
8922@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8923@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8924@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8925
8926@table @code
8927@kindex info sharedlibrary
8928@kindex info share
8929@item info share
8930@itemx info sharedlibrary
8931Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
8932
8933@kindex sharedlibrary
8934@kindex share
8935@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
8936@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
8937Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
8938Unix regular expression.
8939As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
8940required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
8941@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
8942loaded.
8943@end table
8944
53a5351d
JM
8945On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
8946and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
8947a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
c906108c
SS
8948
8949Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
8950loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
8951@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
8952automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
8953
8954To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
8955
8956@table @code
8957@kindex set auto-solib-add
8958@item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
8959Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
8960nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
8961automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
8962linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
8963the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
8964Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8965@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
8966
8967@kindex show auto-solib-add
8968@item show auto-solib-add
8969Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
8970@end table
c906108c 8971
6d2ebf8b 8972@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
8973@section Errors reading symbol files
8974
8975While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
8976such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
8977output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
8978they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
8979debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
8980about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
8981only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
8982times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
8983to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
8984complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8985messages}).
8986
8987The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
8988
8989@table @code
8990@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
8991
8992The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
8993(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
8994error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
8995in its outer scope blocks.
8996
8997@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
8998the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
8999may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9000function.
9001
9002@item block at @var{address} out of order
9003
9004The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9005order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9006do so.
9007
9008@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9009locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9010can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9011@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9012messages}.)
9013
9014@item bad block start address patched
9015
9016The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9017smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9018to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9019
9020@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9021starting on the previous source line.
9022
9023@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9024
9025@cindex foo
9026Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9027larger than the size of the string table.
9028
9029@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9030name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9031with this name.
9032
9033@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9034
7a292a7a
SS
9035The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9036not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 9037uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 9038
7a292a7a
SS
9039@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9040This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 9041are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
9042debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9043on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9044and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
9045
9046@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 9047
7a292a7a 9048@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 9049
7a292a7a 9050@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 9051The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
9052information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9053it.
c906108c
SS
9054
9055@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9056
9057@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 9058
c906108c
SS
9059@end table
9060
6d2ebf8b 9061@node Targets
c906108c 9062@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 9063
c906108c
SS
9064@cindex debugging target
9065@kindex target
9066
9067A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
9068
9069Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9070in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9071you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
9072flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9073host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
9074realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9075command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9076(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
9077
9078@menu
9079* Active Targets:: Active targets
9080* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
9081* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9082* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 9083* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
9084
9085@end menu
9086
6d2ebf8b 9087@node Active Targets
c906108c 9088@section Active targets
7a292a7a 9089
c906108c
SS
9090@cindex stacking targets
9091@cindex active targets
9092@cindex multiple targets
9093
c906108c 9094There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
9095executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9096active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9097start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9098a core file.
c906108c
SS
9099
9100For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9101@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9102well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9103@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9104first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9105requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9106are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9107read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9108executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
9109
9110When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
9111target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9112commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9113an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9114process target is active.
c906108c 9115
7a292a7a
SS
9116Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9117core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 9118files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
9119the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9120process}).
c906108c 9121
6d2ebf8b 9122@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
9123@section Commands for managing targets
9124
9125@table @code
9126@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
9127Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9128process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9129facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9130protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
9131
9132Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9133typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9134with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
9135
9136The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9137after executing the command.
9138
9139@kindex help target
9140@item help target
9141Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9142currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9143(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9144
9145@item help target @var{name}
9146Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9147select it.
9148
9149@kindex set gnutarget
9150@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 9151@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 9152knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
9153a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9154with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
9155with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9156
d4f3574e 9157@quotation
c906108c
SS
9158@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9159you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 9160@end quotation
c906108c 9161
d4f3574e
SS
9162@noindent
9163@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 9164
5d161b24 9165@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
9166@item show gnutarget
9167Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9168@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9169@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9170and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9171@end table
9172
c906108c
SS
9173Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9174configuration):
c906108c
SS
9175
9176@table @code
9177@kindex target exec
9178@item target exec @var{program}
9179An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9180@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9181
c906108c
SS
9182@kindex target core
9183@item target core @var{filename}
9184A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9185@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
9186
9187@kindex target remote
9188@item target remote @var{dev}
9189Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9190specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9191@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9192supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
9193some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9194it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9195
c906108c
SS
9196@kindex target sim
9197@item target sim
2df3850c 9198Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
9199In general,
9200@example
9201 target sim
9202 load
9203 run
9204@end example
d4f3574e 9205@noindent
104c1213 9206works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 9207drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
9208provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9209see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9210Processors}.
9211
c906108c
SS
9212@end table
9213
104c1213 9214Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
9215
9216@table @code
9217
c906108c
SS
9218@kindex target nrom
9219@item target nrom @var{dev}
9220NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9221
c906108c
SS
9222@end table
9223
5d161b24 9224Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 9225your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
9226
9227Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9228once you've successfully established a connection.
9229
9230@table @code
9231
9232@kindex load @var{filename}
9233@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
9234Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9235@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9236is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9237on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9238@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9239the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9240
9241If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9242execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9243target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
9244
9245The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9246For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9247link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9248specifies a fixed address.
9249@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9250
c906108c
SS
9251@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9252@end table
9253
6d2ebf8b 9254@node Byte Order
c906108c 9255@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 9256
c906108c
SS
9257@cindex choosing target byte order
9258@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
9259
9260Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
9261offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
9262orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
9263designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
9264which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 9265@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
9266
9267@table @code
9268@kindex set endian big
9269@item set endian big
9270Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
9271
9272@kindex set endian little
9273@item set endian little
9274Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
9275
9276@kindex set endian auto
9277@item set endian auto
9278Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
9279executable.
9280
9281@item show endian
9282Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
9283
9284@end table
9285
9286Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
9287data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
9288target system.
9289
6d2ebf8b 9290@node Remote
c906108c
SS
9291@section Remote debugging
9292@cindex remote debugging
9293
9294If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
9295@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
9296For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
9297or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
9298powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
9299
9300Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
9301to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 9302@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
9303but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
9304write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
9305communicate with @value{GDBN}.
9306
9307Other remote targets may be available in your
9308configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 9309
c906108c 9310@menu
c906108c 9311* Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
c906108c
SS
9312@end menu
9313
6d2ebf8b 9314@node Remote Serial
104c1213 9315@subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
7a292a7a 9316
104c1213
JM
9317@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
9318To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
9319@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
9320prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
9321program, you need:
c906108c 9322
104c1213
JM
9323@enumerate
9324@item
9325A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
9326have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
9327your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 9328
5d161b24 9329@item
d4f3574e 9330A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 9331subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 9332
104c1213
JM
9333@item
9334A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
9335download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
9336manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
9337documentation.
9338@end enumerate
96baa820 9339
104c1213
JM
9340The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
9341communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
9342machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 9343
104c1213
JM
9344@table @emph
9345@item On the host,
9346@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
9347else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
9348(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
9349
9350@item On the target,
9351you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
9352implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
9353subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
9354
9355On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
9356@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
9357@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
9358@end table
96baa820 9359
104c1213
JM
9360The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
9361machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
9362@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 9363
104c1213
JM
9364@cindex remote serial stub list
9365These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 9366
104c1213
JM
9367@table @code
9368
9369@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 9370@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9371@cindex Intel
9372@cindex i386
9373For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
9374
9375@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 9376@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9377@cindex Motorola 680x0
9378@cindex m680x0
9379For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
9380
9381@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 9382@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9383@cindex Hitachi
9384@cindex SH
9385For Hitachi SH architectures.
9386
9387@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 9388@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9389@cindex Sparc
9390For @sc{sparc} architectures.
9391
9392@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 9393@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
9394@cindex Fujitsu
9395@cindex SparcLite
9396For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
9397
9398@end table
9399
9400The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
9401recently added stubs.
9402
9403@menu
9404* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
9405* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
9406* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
9407* Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
9408* Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
9409* NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
9410@end menu
9411
6d2ebf8b 9412@node Stub Contents
104c1213
JM
9413@subsubsection What the stub can do for you
9414
9415@cindex remote serial stub
9416The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
9417subroutines:
9418
9419@table @code
9420@item set_debug_traps
9421@kindex set_debug_traps
9422@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
9423This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
9424program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
9425beginning of your program.
9426
9427@item handle_exception
9428@kindex handle_exception
9429@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
9430This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
9431explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
9432run when a trap is triggered.
9433
9434@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
9435execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
9436with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
9437protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 9438representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
9439information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
9440retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
9441execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
9442@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 9443machine.
104c1213
JM
9444
9445@item breakpoint
9446@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
9447Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
9448breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
9449way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
9450machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
9451pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
9452@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
9453simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
9454again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
9455your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 9456@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
9457
9458Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
9459to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
9460start of your debugging session.
9461@end table
9462
6d2ebf8b 9463@node Bootstrapping
104c1213
JM
9464@subsubsection What you must do for the stub
9465
9466@cindex remote stub, support routines
9467The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
9468chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
9469debugging target machine.
9470
9471First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
9472serial port.
9473
9474@table @code
9475@item int getDebugChar()
9476@kindex getDebugChar
9477Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
9478It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
9479different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9480
9481@item void putDebugChar(int)
9482@kindex putDebugChar
9483Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 9484It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
9485different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
9486@end table
9487
9488@cindex control C, and remote debugging
9489@cindex interrupting remote targets
9490If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
9491running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
9492for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
9493character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
9494remote system to stop.
9495
9496Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
9497probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
9498is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
9499@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
9500
9501Other routines you need to supply are:
9502
9503@table @code
9504@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
9505@kindex exceptionHandler
9506Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
9507handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
9508way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
9509are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
9510containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
9511@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
9512its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
9513might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
9514exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
9515@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
9516and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
9517you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
9518should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
9519
9520For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
9521gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
9522should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
9523@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
9524help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
9525
9526@item void flush_i_cache()
9527@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 9528On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
9529instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
9530instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
9531
9532On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
9533function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
9534@end table
9535
9536@noindent
9537You must also make sure this library routine is available:
9538
9539@table @code
9540@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
9541@kindex memset
9542This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
9543memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
9544@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
9545either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
9546@end table
9547
9548If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
9549library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
9550but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 9551subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
9552
9553
6d2ebf8b 9554@node Debug Session
104c1213
JM
9555@subsubsection Putting it all together
9556
9557@cindex remote serial debugging summary
9558In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
9559steps.
9560
9561@enumerate
9562@item
6d2ebf8b 9563Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
9564(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
9565@display
9566@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
9567@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
9568@end display
9569
9570@item
9571Insert these lines near the top of your program:
9572
9573@example
9574set_debug_traps();
9575breakpoint();
9576@end example
9577
9578@item
9579For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
9580@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
9581
9582@example
9583void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
9584@end example
9585
d4f3574e 9586@noindent
104c1213 9587but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 9588function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
9589@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
9590error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
9591one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
9592
9593@item
9594Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
9595your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
9596
9597@item
9598Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
9599the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
9600
9601@item
9602@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
9603@c document that. FIXME.
9604Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
9605whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
9606
9607@item
9608To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
9609as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
9610This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
9611of its pure text.
9612
d4f3574e 9613@item
104c1213 9614@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9615Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
9616Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
9617machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
9618TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
9619to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
9620device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
9621
9622@example
9623target remote /dev/ttyb
9624@end example
9625
9626@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
9627To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
9628@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
9629terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
9630
9631@example
9632target remote manyfarms:2828
9633@end example
9634@end enumerate
9635
9636Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
9637step and continue the remote program.
9638
9639To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
9640command.
9641
9642@cindex interrupting remote programs
9643@cindex remote programs, interrupting
9644Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
9645interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
9646program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
9647and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
9648interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
9649
9650@example
9651Interrupted while waiting for the program.
9652Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
9653@end example
9654
9655If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
9656(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
9657remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
9658goes back to waiting.
9659
6d2ebf8b 9660@node Protocol
104c1213
JM
9661@subsubsection Communication protocol
9662
9663@cindex debugging stub, example
9664@cindex remote stub, example
9665@cindex stub example, remote debugging
9666The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
9667communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
9668@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
9669these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
9670implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
9671with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
9672organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
9673
9674However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
9675the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
9676target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
9677it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
9678
9679In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
9680transmitted and received data respectfully.
9681
9682@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
9683@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
9684@cindex remote serial protocol
6cf7e474
AC
9685All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
9686sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
9687@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
9688@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
104c1213
JM
9689
9690@example
9691@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9692@end example
9693@noindent
104c1213
JM
9694
9695@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
9696@noindent
9697The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
6cf7e474
AC
9698characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
9699eight bit unsigned checksum).
9700
9701Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
9702specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
9703
9704@example
9705@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9706@end example
104c1213
JM
9707
9708@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
9709@noindent
6cf7e474
AC
9710That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
9711has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
9712since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
104c1213 9713
6cf7e474 9714@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
104c1213
JM
9715When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
9716response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
9717the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
9718retransmission):
9719
9720@example
9721<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9722-> @code{+}
9723@end example
9724@noindent
104c1213
JM
9725
9726The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
9727debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
9728the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
9729when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
9730
9731@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
6cf7e474
AC
9732exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
9733exceptions).
9734
9735Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
9736@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
9737HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
9738
9739Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
9740@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
9741would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
104c1213
JM
9742
9743Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
c3f6f71d 9744means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
104c1213
JM
9745which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
9746@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
d4f3574e
SS
9747where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
9748characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
9749value greater than 126 should not be used.
9750
9751Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
9752loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
9753character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
104c1213
JM
9754
9755So:
9756@example
9757"@code{0* }"
9758@end example
9759@noindent
9760means the same as "0000".
9761
598ca718 9762The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
104c1213
JM
9763error number. That number is not well defined.
9764
9765For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
9766(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
9767protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
d4f3574e 9768on that response.
104c1213 9769
f1251bdd
C
9770A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
9771@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
9772optional.
9773
104c1213
JM
9774Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
9775their corresponding response @var{data}:
598ca718 9776@page
104c1213
JM
9777@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
9778@item Packet
9779@tab Request
9780@tab Description
9781
df2396a1 9782@item extended mode
104c1213
JM
9783@tab @code{!}
9784@tab
df2396a1 9785Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
656db9b0 9786persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
df2396a1 9787debugged.
104c1213 9788@item
df2396a1 9789@tab reply @samp{OK}
104c1213 9790@tab
df2396a1 9791The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
104c1213
JM
9792
9793@item last signal
9794@tab @code{?}
9795@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9796Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
9797and continue.
9798@item
9799@tab reply
9800@tab see below
9801
104c1213
JM
9802
9803@item reserved
9804@tab @code{a}
5d161b24 9805@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9806
f1251bdd 9807@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9808@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
9809@tab
598ca718
EZ
9810@item
9811@tab
9812@tab
104c1213
JM
9813Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
9814specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
d4f3574e 9815See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
104c1213
JM
9816@item
9817@tab reply @code{OK}
9818@item
9819@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9820
9821@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
9822@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
9823@tab
9824Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
9825transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
9826transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
9827acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
9828to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
9829ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
9830specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
9831that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
9832happened.}
9833
9834@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
9835@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
9836@tab
9837Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
9838breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
9839@samp{z} packets.}
9840
9841@item continue
9842@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
9843@tab
9844@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9845current address.
9846@item
9847@tab reply
9848@tab see below
9849
f1251bdd 9850@item continue with signal
104c1213
JM
9851@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9852@tab
9853Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
9854@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
9855@item
9856@tab reply
9857@tab see below
9858
598ca718 9859@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
104c1213
JM
9860@tab @code{d}
9861@tab
d4f3574e 9862toggle debug flag.
104c1213 9863
f1251bdd 9864@item detach
104c1213 9865@tab @code{D}
d4f3574e 9866@tab
2df3850c
JM
9867Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
9868@value{GDBN} disconnects.
d4f3574e
SS
9869@item
9870@tab reply @emph{no response}
9871@tab
598ca718 9872@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
104c1213
JM
9873
9874@item reserved
9875@tab @code{e}
5d161b24 9876@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9877
9878@item reserved
9879@tab @code{E}
5d161b24 9880@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9881
9882@item reserved
9883@tab @code{f}
5d161b24 9884@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9885
9886@item reserved
9887@tab @code{F}
5d161b24 9888@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9889
9890@item read registers
9891@tab @code{g}
9892@tab Read general registers.
9893@item
9894@tab reply @var{XX...}
9895@tab
9896Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
9897with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
d4f3574e 9898each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
2df3850c 9899determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
d4f3574e
SS
9900@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
9901@code{g} packets is specified below.
104c1213
JM
9902@item
9903@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
9904@tab for an error.
9905
9906@item write regs
9907@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
9908@tab
9909See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
9910@item
9911@tab reply @code{OK}
9912@tab for success
9913@item
9914@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9915@tab for an error
9916
9917@item reserved
9918@tab @code{h}
5d161b24 9919@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9920
f1251bdd 9921@item set thread
104c1213
JM
9922@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
9923@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9924Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
9925@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
9926continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
9927thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
104c1213
JM
9928@item
9929@tab reply @code{OK}
9930@tab for success
9931@item
9932@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9933@tab for an error
9934
d4f3574e
SS
9935@c FIXME: JTC:
9936@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
5d161b24 9937@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
d4f3574e
SS
9938@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
9939@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
9940@c described. For example:
9941@c
9942@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9943@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
9944@c otherwise returns current registers.
9945@c
9946@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9947@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
9948@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
9949
f1251bdd 9950@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
9951@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
9952@tab
9953Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
9954present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
9955step starting at that address.
9956
f1251bdd 9957@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
104c1213
JM
9958@tab @code{I}
9959@tab
9960See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
9961
9962@item reserved
9963@tab @code{j}
9964@tab Reserved for future use
9965
9966@item reserved
9967@tab @code{J}
5d161b24 9968@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 9969
f1251bdd 9970@item kill request
104c1213
JM
9971@tab @code{k}
9972@tab
d4f3574e
SS
9973FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
9974thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
104c1213
JM
9975
9976@item reserved
9977@tab @code{l}
5d161b24 9978@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9979
9980@item reserved
9981@tab @code{L}
5d161b24 9982@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
9983
9984@item read memory
9985@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9986@tab
9987Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
2df3850c 9988Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
d4f3574e
SS
9989using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
9990transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9991@item
9992@tab reply @var{XX...}
9993@tab
d4f3574e 9994@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
2df3850c 9995to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
d4f3574e
SS
9996sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
9997@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
104c1213
JM
9998@item
9999@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10000@tab @var{NN} is errno
10001
10002@item write mem
10003@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
10004@tab
10005Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
10006@var{XX...} is the data.
10007@item
10008@tab reply @code{OK}
10009@tab for success
10010@item
10011@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10012@tab
10013for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
10014written).
10015
10016@item reserved
10017@tab @code{n}
5d161b24 10018@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10019
10020@item reserved
10021@tab @code{N}
5d161b24 10022@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10023
10024@item reserved
10025@tab @code{o}
5d161b24 10026@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10027
10028@item reserved
10029@tab @code{O}
5d161b24 10030@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10031
10032@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
10033@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
10034@tab
10035See write register.
10036@item
10037@tab return @var{r....}
10038@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
10039
f1251bdd 10040@item write reg
104c1213
JM
10041@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
10042@tab
10043Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
10044digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
10045@item
10046@tab reply @code{OK}
10047@tab for success
10048@item
10049@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10050@tab for an error
10051
f1251bdd 10052@item general query
104c1213
JM
10053@tab @code{q}@var{query}
10054@tab
598ca718 10055Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
104c1213 10056have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
d4f3574e
SS
10057company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
10058optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
10059must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
104c1213
JM
10060@item
10061@tab reply @code{XX...}
d4f3574e 10062@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
104c1213
JM
10063@item
10064@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10065@tab error reply
10066@item
10067@tab reply @samp{}
10068@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
10069
f1251bdd 10070@item general set
104c1213
JM
10071@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
10072@tab
10073Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
10074naming conventions.
10075
598ca718 10076@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
d4f3574e
SS
10077@tab @code{r}
10078@tab
10079Reset the entire system.
104c1213 10080
f1251bdd 10081@item remote restart
104c1213
JM
10082@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
10083@tab
df2396a1
AC
10084Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
10085This packet is only available in extended mode.
10086@item
10087@tab
10088no reply
10089@tab
10090The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
104c1213 10091
f1251bdd 10092@item step
104c1213
JM
10093@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
10094@tab
10095@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
10096same address.
10097@item
10098@tab reply
10099@tab see below
10100
f1251bdd 10101@item step with signal
104c1213
JM
10102@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
10103@tab
10104Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
10105@item
10106@tab reply
10107@tab see below
10108
f1251bdd 10109@item search
104c1213
JM
10110@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
10111@tab
10112Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
10113@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
d4f3574e 10114bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
104c1213 10115
f1251bdd 10116@item thread alive
104c1213
JM
10117@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
10118@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
10119@item
10120@tab reply @code{OK}
10121@tab thread is still alive
10122@item
10123@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10124@tab thread is dead
5d161b24 10125
104c1213
JM
10126@item reserved
10127@tab @code{u}
5d161b24 10128@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10129
10130@item reserved
10131@tab @code{U}
5d161b24 10132@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10133
10134@item reserved
10135@tab @code{v}
5d161b24 10136@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10137
10138@item reserved
10139@tab @code{V}
5d161b24 10140@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10141
10142@item reserved
10143@tab @code{w}
5d161b24 10144@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10145
10146@item reserved
10147@tab @code{W}
5d161b24 10148@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10149
10150@item reserved
10151@tab @code{x}
5d161b24 10152@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10153
f1251bdd 10154@item write mem (binary)
104c1213
JM
10155@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
10156@tab
10157@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
d4f3574e
SS
10158binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
10159escaped using @code{0x7d}.
104c1213
JM
10160@item
10161@tab reply @code{OK}
10162@tab for success
10163@item
10164@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10165@tab for an error
10166
10167@item reserved
10168@tab @code{y}
5d161b24 10169@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10170
10171@item reserved
10172@tab @code{Y}
5d161b24 10173@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213 10174
f1251bdd 10175@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10176@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10177@tab
10178See @samp{Z}.
10179
f1251bdd 10180@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
104c1213
JM
10181@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10182@tab
10183@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
10184breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
10185@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
10186bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
10187the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
d4f3574e
SS
10188@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
10189potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
6d2ebf8b 10190implemented in an idempotent way.
104c1213
JM
10191@item
10192@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10193@tab for an error
10194@item
10195@tab reply @code{OK}
10196@tab for success
10197@item
10198@tab @samp{}
10199@tab If not supported.
10200
10201@item reserved
10202@tab <other>
5d161b24 10203@tab Reserved for future use
104c1213
JM
10204
10205@end multitable
10206
d4f3574e
SS
10207The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
10208receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
10209@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
10210when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
10211number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
10212conventions is used.
104c1213
JM
10213
10214@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
10215
10216@item @code{S}@var{AA}
10217@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
10218
10219@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
10220@tab
10221@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
10222(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
10223by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
10224thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
d4f3574e 10225starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
104c1213
JM
10226@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
10227extend the protocol.
10228
10229@item @code{W}@var{AA}
10230@tab
10231The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
10232applicable for certains sorts of targets.
10233
10234@item @code{X}@var{AA}
10235@tab
10236The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
10237
6d2ebf8b 10238@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
104c1213 10239@tab
6d2ebf8b
SS
10240@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
10241@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
10242@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
10243this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
10244spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
10245debugger.}
104c1213
JM
10246
10247@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
10248@tab
c3f6f71d 10249@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
104c1213
JM
10250while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
10251for 'W', 'T', etc.
10252
10253@end multitable
10254
d4f3574e
SS
10255The following set and query packets have already been defined.
10256
10257@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
10258
10259@item current thread
10260@tab @code{q}@code{C}
10261@tab Return the current thread id.
10262@item
10263@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
10264@tab
10265Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
10266@item
10267@tab reply *
10268@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
10269
bba2971c
MS
10270@item all thread ids
10271@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10272@item
10273@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
d4f3574e 10274@tab
bba2971c
MS
10275Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
10276may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
10277works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
10278obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
5d161b24 10279be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
bba2971c 10280sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
d4f3574e 10281@item
bba2971c
MS
10282@tab
10283@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
d4f3574e 10284@item
5d161b24 10285@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
bba2971c
MS
10286@tab A single thread id
10287@item
00e4a2e4 10288@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
bba2971c
MS
10289@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
10290@item
10291@tab reply @code{l}
10292@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
10293@item
10294@tab
10295@tab
10296In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
10297or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
10298respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
10299@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
10300(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
10301
10302@item extra thread info
480ff1fb 10303@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
bba2971c
MS
10304@tab
10305@item
10306@tab
10307@tab
10308Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
10309Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
10310the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
10311thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
10312The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
5d161b24 10313Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
bba2971c
MS
10314"Blocked on Mutex".
10315@item
10316@tab reply @var{XX...}
10317@tab
10318Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
10319printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
10320attributes.
d4f3574e
SS
10321
10322@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
10323@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
10324@tab
2b628194
MS
10325@item
10326@tab
10327@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10328Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
10329digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
10330subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
10331number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
10332(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
10333returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
10334@item
bba2971c
MS
10335@tab
10336@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
10337query (see above).
10338@item
d4f3574e
SS
10339@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
10340@tab
2b628194
MS
10341@item
10342@tab
10343@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10344Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
10345returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
10346and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
10347digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
10348a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
10349digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
10350
bba2971c
MS
10351@item compute CRC of memory block
10352@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
10353@tab
10354@item
10355@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10356@tab An error (such as memory fault)
10357@item
10358@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
10359@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
10360
d4f3574e
SS
10361@item query sect offs
10362@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
917317f4
JM
10363@tab
10364Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
10365image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
10366response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
10367offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
d4f3574e
SS
10368@item
10369@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
10370
10371@item thread info request
10372@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
10373@tab
598ca718
EZ
10374@item
10375@tab
10376@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10377Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
10378encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
10379@item
10380@tab reply *
10381@tab
10382See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
10383
10384@item remote command
10385@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
10386@tab
598ca718
EZ
10387@item
10388@tab
10389@tab
d4f3574e
SS
10390@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
10391execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
10392Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
10393number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
10394packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
10395stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
10396@item
10397@tab reply @code{OK}
10398@tab
10399A command response with no output.
10400@item
10401@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
10402@tab
10403A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
10404@item
10405@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
10406@tab
10407Indicate a badly formed request.
10408
10409@item
10410@tab reply @samp{}
10411@tab
10412When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
10413
0f1f2b0a
MS
10414@item symbol lookup
10415@tab @code{qSymbol::}
10416@tab
10417Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
10418requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
10419@item
10420@tab
10421@tab
10422@item
10423@tab reply @code{OK}
10424@tab
10425The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
10426@item
10427@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
10428@tab
10429The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
10430@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
10431@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
10432message, described below.
10433
10434@item symbol value
10435@tab @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
10436@tab
10437Set the value of SYM_NAME to SYM_VALUE.
10438@item
10439@tab
10440@tab
10441@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value
10442the target has previously requested.
10443@item
10444@tab
10445@tab
10446@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}.
10447If @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this
10448field will be empty.
10449@item
10450@tab reply @code{OK}
10451@tab
10452The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
10453@item
10454@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
10455@tab
10456The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
10457@value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols (if available),
10458until the target ceases to request them.
10459
d4f3574e
SS
10460@end multitable
10461
10462The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
10463In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
10464bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
10465space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
10466The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
10467least-significant.
10468
10469@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
10470
10471@item MIPS32
10472@tab
10473All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1047432 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
10475registers; fsr; fir; fp.
10476
10477@item MIPS64
10478@tab
10479All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
10480thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
10481as @code{MIPS32}.
10482
10483@end multitable
10484
104c1213
JM
10485Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
10486does not get any direct output:
10487
10488@example
10489<- @code{R00}
10490-> @code{+}
10491@emph{target restarts}
10492<- @code{?}
10493-> @code{+}
10494-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10495<- @code{+}
10496@end example
10497
10498Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
10499
10500@example
10501<- @code{G1445...}
10502-> @code{+}
10503<- @code{s}
10504-> @code{+}
10505@emph{time passes}
10506-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
10507<- @code{+}
10508<- @code{g}
10509-> @code{+}
10510-> @code{1455...}
10511<- @code{+}
10512@end example
10513
6d2ebf8b 10514@node Server
104c1213
JM
10515@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10516
10517@kindex gdbserver
10518@cindex remote connection without stubs
10519@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10520allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10521@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10522
10523@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10524because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10525that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10526@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10527@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10528because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10529also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10530started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10531Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10532the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10533do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10534by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10535choice for debugging.
10536
10537@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10538or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10539protocol.
10540
10541@table @emph
10542@item On the target machine,
10543you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10544@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10545strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10546system does all the symbol handling.
10547
10548To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10549the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
10550syntax is:
10551
10552@smallexample
10553target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10554@end smallexample
10555
10556@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10557hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10558@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10559@file{/dev/com1}:
10560
10561@smallexample
10562target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10563@end smallexample
10564
10565@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10566with it.
10567
10568To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10569
10570@smallexample
10571target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10572@end smallexample
10573
10574The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10575specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10576TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10577expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10578(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10579you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10580TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10581reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10582conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
d4f3574e 10583and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
10584@code{target remote} command.
10585
10586@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10587you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10588symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10589using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10590(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 10591running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
10592remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10593is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10594@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10595@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10596
10597@smallexample
10598(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10599@end smallexample
10600
10601@noindent
10602communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10603
10604@smallexample
10605(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10606@end smallexample
10607
10608@noindent
10609communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10610For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10611the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10612text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10613@samp{Connection refused}.
10614@end table
10615
6d2ebf8b 10616@node NetWare
104c1213
JM
10617@subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10618
10619@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10620@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10621allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10622@code{target remote}.
10623
10624@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10625using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10626
10627@table @emph
10628@item On the target machine,
10629you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10630@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10631can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10632host system does all the symbol handling.
10633
10634To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10635@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10636program. The syntax is:
10637
5d161b24 10638@smallexample
104c1213
JM
10639load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10640 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10641@end smallexample
10642
10643@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10644the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
d4f3574e 10645to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
104c1213
JM
10646
10647For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
5d161b24 10648communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
d4f3574e 10649using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
104c1213
JM
10650
10651@smallexample
10652load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10653@end smallexample
10654
10655@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10656you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10657symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10658using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10659(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
d4f3574e 10660running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
104c1213
JM
10661remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10662argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10663@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10664
10665@smallexample
10666(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10667@end smallexample
10668
10669@noindent
10670communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10671@end table
10672
6d2ebf8b 10673@node KOD
104c1213
JM
10674@section Kernel Object Display
10675
10676@cindex kernel object display
10677@cindex kernel object
10678@cindex KOD
10679
10680Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10681@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10682and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10683mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10684displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10685
10686Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10687@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10688
10689@example
2df3850c 10690(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
104c1213
JM
10691@end example
10692
10693If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10694about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10695which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10696after the operating system:
10697
10698@example
2df3850c 10699(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
104c1213
JM
10700List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10701Object Description
10702any Any and all objects
10703@end example
10704
10705Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10706by the kernel.
10707
10708There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
96baa820
JM
10709is supported other than to try it.
10710
10711
6d2ebf8b 10712@node Configurations
104c1213
JM
10713@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
10714
10715While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10716cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10717describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
10718
10719There are three major categories of configurations: native
10720configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10721operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10722different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10723are quite different from each other.
10724
10725@menu
10726* Native::
10727* Embedded OS::
10728* Embedded Processors::
10729* Architectures::
10730@end menu
10731
6d2ebf8b 10732@node Native
104c1213
JM
10733@section Native
10734
10735This section describes details specific to particular native
10736configurations.
10737
10738@menu
10739* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10740* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10741@end menu
10742
6d2ebf8b 10743@node HP-UX
104c1213
JM
10744@subsection HP-UX
10745
10746On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10747begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10748name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10749
6d2ebf8b 10750@node SVR4 Process Information
104c1213
JM
10751@subsection SVR4 process information
10752
10753@kindex /proc
10754@cindex process image
10755
10756Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10757used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10758subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10759this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10760several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10761@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10762@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10763and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
10764
10765@table @code
10766@kindex info proc
10767@item info proc
10768Summarize available information about the process.
10769
10770@kindex info proc mappings
10771@item info proc mappings
10772Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10773on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10774
10775@kindex info proc times
10776@item info proc times
10777Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10778its children.
10779
10780@kindex info proc id
10781@item info proc id
10782Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10783the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
10784
10785@kindex info proc status
10786@item info proc status
10787General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10788stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10789received.
10790
10791@item info proc all
10792Show all the above information about the process.
10793@end table
10794
6d2ebf8b 10795@node Embedded OS
104c1213
JM
10796@section Embedded Operating Systems
10797
10798This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10799embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10800architectures.
10801
10802@menu
10803* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10804@end menu
10805
10806@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10807various real-time operating systems.
10808
6d2ebf8b 10809@node VxWorks
104c1213
JM
10810@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10811
10812@cindex VxWorks
10813
10814@table @code
10815
10816@kindex target vxworks
10817@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10818A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10819is the target system's machine name or IP address.
10820
10821@end table
10822
10823On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
10824current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
10825
10826@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
10827VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
10828the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10829both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
d4f3574e 10830@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
104c1213 10831installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
96a2c332 10832@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213
JM
10833
10834@table @code
10835@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
10836@kindex vxworks-timeout
5d161b24
DB
10837All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
10838This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10839seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
10840your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
104c1213
JM
10841of a thin network line.
10842@end table
10843
10844The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
10845this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
10846procedures.
10847
10848@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
10849To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
10850to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
10851library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
10852VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
10853kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
10854source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
10855information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
10856manual.
10857@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
10858
10859Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
10860your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
96a2c332
SS
10861run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
10862@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213
JM
10863
10864@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10865
10866@example
10867(vxgdb)
10868@end example
10869
10870@menu
10871* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
10872* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
10873* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
10874@end menu
10875
6d2ebf8b 10876@node VxWorks Connection
104c1213
JM
10877@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
10878
10879The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10880network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
10881
10882@example
10883(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
10884@end example
10885
10886@need 750
10887@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10888
10889@smallexample
5d161b24 10890Attaching remote machine across net...
104c1213
JM
10891Connected to tt.
10892@end smallexample
10893
10894@need 1000
10895@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10896loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
10897these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10898path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10899to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
10900
10901@example
10902prog.o: No such file or directory.
10903@end example
10904
10905When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10906the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10907command again.
10908
6d2ebf8b 10909@node VxWorks Download
104c1213
JM
10910@subsubsection VxWorks download
10911
10912@cindex download to VxWorks
10913If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10914object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10915@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10916incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10917command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10918to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10919table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10920the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10921filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10922Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10923to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10924the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
10925@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10926and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
10927program, type this on VxWorks:
10928
10929@example
10930-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
10931@end example
d4f3574e
SS
10932
10933@noindent
104c1213
JM
10934Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10935
10936@example
5d161b24 10937(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
104c1213
JM
10938(vxgdb) load prog.o
10939@end example
10940
10941@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
10942
10943@smallexample
10944Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
10945@end smallexample
10946
10947You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
10948after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
10949this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
10950auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
10951history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
d4f3574e 10952debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
104c1213
JM
10953table.)
10954
6d2ebf8b 10955@node VxWorks Attach
104c1213
JM
10956@subsubsection Running tasks
10957
10958@cindex running VxWorks tasks
10959You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
10960follows:
10961
10962@example
10963(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
10964@end example
10965
10966@noindent
10967where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
10968or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
10969the time of attachment.
10970
6d2ebf8b 10971@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
10972@section Embedded Processors
10973
10974This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
10975configurations.
10976
10977@menu
10978* A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
10979* ARM:: ARM
10980* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
10981* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
10982* i960:: Intel i960
10983* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
10984* M68K:: Motorola M68K
10985* M88K:: Motorola M88K
10986* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
10987* PA:: HP PA Embedded
10988* PowerPC: PowerPC
10989* SH:: Hitachi SH
10990* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
10991* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
10992* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
10993* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
10994@end menu
10995
6d2ebf8b 10996@node A29K Embedded
104c1213
JM
10997@subsection AMD A29K Embedded
10998
10999@menu
11000* A29K UDI::
11001* A29K EB29K::
11002* Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
11003* gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
11004* Remote Log:: Remote log
11005@end menu
11006
11007@table @code
11008
11009@kindex target adapt
11010@item target adapt @var{dev}
11011Adapt monitor for A29K.
11012
11013@kindex target amd-eb
11014@item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
11015@cindex AMD EB29K
11016Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
11017@var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
11018@var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
11019name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
11020@xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
11021
11022@end table
11023
6d2ebf8b 11024@node A29K UDI
104c1213
JM
11025@subsubsection A29K UDI
11026
11027@cindex UDI
11028@cindex AMD29K via UDI
11029
11030@value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
11031protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
11032configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
11033program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
11034use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
11035@code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
11036
11037@table @code
11038@item target udi @var{keyword}
11039@kindex udi
11040Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
11041@var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
11042This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
11043connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
11044working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
11045to its pathname.
11046@end table
11047
6d2ebf8b 11048@node A29K EB29K
104c1213
JM
11049@subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
11050
11051@cindex EB29K board
11052@cindex running 29K programs
11053
11054AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
11055with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
11056term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
11057@value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
11058must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
11059board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
11060assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
11061@file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
11062
6d2ebf8b 11063@node Comms (EB29K)
104c1213
JM
11064@subsubsection Communications setup
11065
11066The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
11067in DOS on the PC:
11068
11069@example
11070C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
11071@end example
11072
11073@noindent
11074This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
11075bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
11076you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
11077end of the connection as well.
11078@c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
5d161b24 11079@c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
11080@c
11081@c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
11082@c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
11083@c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
11084@c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
11085@c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
104c1213
JM
11086
11087To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
11088the following at the DOS console:
11089
11090@example
11091C:\> CTTY com1
11092@end example
11093
11094@noindent
11095(Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
11096the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
96a2c332 11097had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
104c1213
JM
11098
11099From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
11100@code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
11101
11102@example
11103cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
11104@end example
11105
11106@noindent
11107The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
11108serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
11109may look something like the following:
11110
11111@example
11112tip -9600 /dev/ttya
11113@end example
11114
11115@noindent
11116Your system may require a different name where we show
11117@file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
11118parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
11119@code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
11120system table @file{/etc/remote}.
11121@c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
11122@c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
11123@c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
11124@c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
11125@c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
11126@c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
11127@c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
d4f3574e
SS
11128@c
11129@c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
11130@c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
11131@c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
104c1213
JM
11132
11133@kindex EBMON
11134Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
11135directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
11136start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
11137with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
11138@code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
11139@code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
11140
11141@example
11142C:\> G:
11143
11144G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
11145
11146G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
11147Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
11148Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
11149Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
11150
11151Enter '?' or 'H' for help
11152
11153PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
11154I/O Base = 0x208
11155Memory Base = 0xd0000
11156
11157Data Memory Size = 2048KB
11158Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
11159Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
11160
11161PageSize = 0x400
11162Register Stack Size = 0x800
11163Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
11164
11165CPU PRL = 0x3
11166Am29027 Available = No
11167Byte Write Available = Yes
11168
11169# ~.
11170@end example
11171
11172Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
11173typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
11174running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
11175
11176For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
11177way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
d4f3574e 11178system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
104c1213
JM
11179PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
11180something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
11181other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
11182from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
11183serial line.
11184
6d2ebf8b 11185@node gdb-EB29K
104c1213
JM
11186@subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
11187
11188Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
11189program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
11190name of your 29K program:
11191
11192@example
11193cd /usr/joe/work29k
11194@value{GDBP} myfoo
11195@end example
11196
11197@need 500
11198Now you can use the @code{target} command:
11199
11200@example
11201target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
11202@c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
11203@c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
11204@c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11205@end example
11206
11207@noindent
11208In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
11209@file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
11210@code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
11211In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
11212a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
11213the name on the Unix side.
11214
11215At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
11216to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
11217@code{run}.
11218
11219To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
11220command.
11221
11222To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
11223once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
11224@code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
11225@code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
d4f3574e 11226Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
104c1213
JM
11227and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
11228
6d2ebf8b 11229@node Remote Log
104c1213 11230@subsubsection Remote log
41afff9a 11231@cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
104c1213
JM
11232@cindex log file for EB29K
11233
11234The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
11235current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
11236@file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
11237of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
11238another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
11239unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
11240
6d2ebf8b 11241@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11242@subsection ARM
11243
11244@table @code
11245
11246@kindex target rdi
11247@item target rdi @var{dev}
11248ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11249use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11250monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
5d161b24 11251
104c1213
JM
11252@kindex target rdp
11253@item target rdp @var{dev}
11254ARM Demon monitor.
11255
11256@end table
11257
6d2ebf8b 11258@node H8/300
104c1213
JM
11259@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11260
11261@table @code
11262
d4f3574e 11263@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
11264@item target hms @var{dev}
11265A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11266Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11267line and the communications speed used.
11268
d4f3574e 11269@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213
JM
11270@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11271E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11272
d4f3574e
SS
11273@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11274@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
104c1213 11275@item target sh3 @var{dev}
96a2c332 11276@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
104c1213
JM
11277Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11278
11279@end table
11280
11281@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11282@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11283@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11284@cindex Hitachi SH download
11285When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11286board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11287board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11288@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11289
11290@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
5d161b24 11291Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
104c1213
JM
11292
11293@enumerate
11294@item
11295that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11296for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11297emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
2df3850c 11298the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
104c1213
JM
11299H8/300, or H8/500.)
11300
11301@item
11302what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11303serial device available on your host is the default).
11304
11305@item
11306what speed to use over the serial device.
11307@end enumerate
11308
11309@menu
11310* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11311* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11312* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11313@end menu
11314
6d2ebf8b 11315@node Hitachi Boards
104c1213
JM
11316@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11317
11318@c only for Unix hosts
11319@kindex device
11320@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 11321Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
104c1213
JM
11322need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11323first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11324hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11325
11326@kindex speed
11327@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
96a2c332 11328@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
104c1213 11329speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
2df3850c 11330hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
d4f3574e
SS
11331the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11332@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
104c1213
JM
11333
11334The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11335use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11336use a DOS host,
11337@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11338called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11339through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11340to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11341
11342The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11343program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11344sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11345the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11346
11347First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11348board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11349port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11350When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
d4f3574e 11351debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
104c1213
JM
11352for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11353@code{COM2}.
11354
11355@example
11356C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11357C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11358
11359Resident portion of MODE loaded
11360
11361COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11362
11363@end example
11364
11365@quotation
11366@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11367@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11368disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11369your development board.
11370@end quotation
11371
d4f3574e 11372@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
104c1213
JM
11373Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11374connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
96a2c332 11375the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
104c1213
JM
11376you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11377commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11378cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11379download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11380the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11381(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11382executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11383@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11384itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11385
11386@smallexample
11387(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
2df3850c 11388@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 11389 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
104c1213 11390 the conditions.
5d161b24 11391There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
104c1213 11392for details.
2df3850c
JM
11393@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11394(@value{GDBP}) target hms
104c1213 11395Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
2df3850c 11396(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
104c1213
JM
11397.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11398.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11399.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11400@end smallexample
11401
11402At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11403you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11404sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11405@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11406resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11407@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11408
11409Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11410available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11411you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11412
11413Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11414@itemize @bullet
11415@item
11416to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11417no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11418
11419@item
11420to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11421normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11422to detect program completion.
11423@end itemize
11424
11425In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11426development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11427
6d2ebf8b 11428@node Hitachi ICE
104c1213
JM
11429@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11430
d4f3574e 11431@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
104c1213
JM
11432You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11433Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11434e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11435
11436@table @code
11437@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11438Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11439@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11440@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11441(for example, @samp{9600}).
11442
11443@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11444If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11445specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11446@end table
11447
6d2ebf8b 11448@node Hitachi Special
104c1213
JM
11449@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11450
11451Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11452
11453@table @code
11454
11455@kindex set machine
11456@kindex show machine
11457@item set machine h8300
11458@itemx set machine h8300h
11459Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11460architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11461to check which variant is currently in effect.
11462
11463@end table
11464
6d2ebf8b 11465@node H8/500
104c1213
JM
11466@subsection H8/500
11467
11468@table @code
11469
11470@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11471@cindex memory models, H8/500
11472@item set memory @var{mod}
11473@itemx show memory
11474Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11475@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11476memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11477@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
11478
11479@end table
11480
6d2ebf8b 11481@node i960
104c1213
JM
11482@subsection Intel i960
11483
11484@table @code
11485
11486@kindex target mon960
11487@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11488MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
11489
f0ca3dce 11490@kindex target nindy
104c1213
JM
11491@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11492An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11493the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11494@file{/dev/ttya}.
11495
11496@end table
11497
11498@cindex Nindy
11499@cindex i960
11500@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11501@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11502tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11503
11504@itemize @bullet
11505@item
11506Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11507Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
11508
11509@item
11510By responding to a prompt on startup;
11511
11512@item
11513By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11514session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11515
104c1213
JM
11516@end itemize
11517
11518@cindex download to Nindy-960
11519With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11520downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11521@value{GDBN}.
11522
11523@menu
11524* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11525* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11526* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11527@end menu
11528
6d2ebf8b 11529@node Nindy Startup
104c1213
JM
11530@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11531
11532If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11533options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11534reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11535
11536@example
5d161b24 11537Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
104c1213
JM
11538@end example
11539
11540@noindent
11541Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11542identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11543simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11544with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11545use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11546
6d2ebf8b 11547@node Nindy Options
104c1213
JM
11548@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11549
11550These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11551Nindy-960 board attached:
11552
11553@table @code
11554@item -r @var{port}
11555Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11556to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11557configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11558@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11559device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11560suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11561
11562@item -O
11563(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11564the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11565This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11566target architecture.
11567
11568@quotation
11569@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11570connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11571fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11572attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11573this process with an interrupt.
11574@end quotation
11575
11576@item -brk
11577Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11578system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11579
11580@quotation
11581@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11582requires; it only works with a few boards.
11583@end quotation
11584@end table
11585
11586The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11587port.
11588
11589@c @group
6d2ebf8b 11590@node Nindy Reset
104c1213
JM
11591@subsubsection Nindy reset command
11592
11593@table @code
11594@item reset
11595@kindex reset
11596For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11597system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11598circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11599a break is detected.
11600@end table
11601@c @end group
11602
6d2ebf8b 11603@node M32R/D
104c1213
JM
11604@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11605
11606@table @code
11607
11608@kindex target m32r
11609@item target m32r @var{dev}
11610Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11611
11612@end table
11613
6d2ebf8b 11614@node M68K
104c1213
JM
11615@subsection M68k
11616
11617The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11618target command for the following ROM monitors.
11619
11620@table @code
11621
11622@kindex target abug
11623@item target abug @var{dev}
11624ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11625
11626@kindex target cpu32bug
11627@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11628CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11629
11630@kindex target dbug
11631@item target dbug @var{dev}
11632dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11633
11634@kindex target est
11635@item target est @var{dev}
11636EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11637
11638@kindex target rom68k
11639@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11640ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11641
11642@end table
11643
11644If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11645instead have only a single special target command:
11646
11647@table @code
11648
11649@kindex target es1800
11650@item target es1800 @var{dev}
11651ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11652
11653@end table
11654
11655[context?]
11656
11657@table @code
11658
11659@kindex target rombug
11660@item target rombug @var{dev}
11661ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11662
11663@end table
11664
6d2ebf8b 11665@node M88K
104c1213
JM
11666@subsection M88K
11667
11668@table @code
11669
11670@kindex target bug
11671@item target bug @var{dev}
11672BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
11673
11674@end table
11675
6d2ebf8b 11676@node MIPS Embedded
104c1213
JM
11677@subsection MIPS Embedded
11678
11679@cindex MIPS boards
11680@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11681MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11682you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
11683
11684@need 1000
11685Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
11686
11687@table @code
11688@item target mips @var{port}
11689@kindex target mips @var{port}
11690To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11691name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11692command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11693the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11694been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11695download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
11696
11697For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11698port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11699debugger:
11700
11701@example
11702host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
2df3850c
JM
11703@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11704(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11705(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11706(@value{GDBP}) run
104c1213
JM
11707@end example
11708
11709@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11710On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11711connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11712concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11713@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11714
11715@item target pmon @var{port}
11716@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11717PMON ROM monitor.
11718
11719@item target ddb @var{port}
11720@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11721NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
11722
11723@item target lsi @var{port}
11724@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11725LSI variant of PMON.
11726
11727@kindex target r3900
11728@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11729Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
11730
11731@kindex target array
11732@item target array @var{dev}
11733Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
11734
11735@end table
11736
11737
11738@noindent
11739@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
11740
11741@table @code
11742@item set processor @var{args}
11743@itemx show processor
11744@kindex set processor @var{args}
11745@kindex show processor
11746Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11747processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
5d161b24 11748For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
96c405b3 11749to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
5d161b24 11750Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
104c1213 11751is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
5d161b24 11752@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213
JM
11753
11754@item set mipsfpu double
11755@itemx set mipsfpu single
11756@itemx set mipsfpu none
11757@itemx show mipsfpu
11758@kindex set mipsfpu
11759@kindex show mipsfpu
11760@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11761@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11762If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11763coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
96a2c332 11764need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
104c1213
JM
11765file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11766functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11767@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11768functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11769with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11770processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11771double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11772@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
11773
11774In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11775floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11776and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
11777
11778As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11779@samp{show mipsfpu}.
11780
11781@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11782@itemx show remotedebug
d4f3574e
SS
11783@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11784@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
104c1213
JM
11785@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11786@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11787@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11788@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11789You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11790by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11791@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11792to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11793at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
11794
11795@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11796@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11797@itemx show timeout
11798@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11799@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11800@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11801@kindex set timeout
11802@kindex show timeout
11803@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11804@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11805You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11806remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11807default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11808waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11809retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11810You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11811retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11812@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
11813
11814The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11815is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11816forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11817to run before stopping.
11818@end table
11819
6d2ebf8b 11820@node PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11821@subsection PowerPC
11822
11823@table @code
11824
11825@kindex target dink32
11826@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11827DINK32 ROM monitor.
11828
11829@kindex target ppcbug
11830@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11831@kindex target ppcbug1
11832@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11833PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
11834
11835@kindex target sds
11836@item target sds @var{dev}
11837SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11838
11839@end table
11840
6d2ebf8b 11841@node PA
104c1213
JM
11842@subsection HP PA Embedded
11843
11844@table @code
11845
11846@kindex target op50n
11847@item target op50n @var{dev}
11848OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11849
11850@kindex target w89k
11851@item target w89k @var{dev}
11852W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
11853
11854@end table
11855
6d2ebf8b 11856@node SH
104c1213
JM
11857@subsection Hitachi SH
11858
11859@table @code
11860
d4f3574e 11861@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
11862@item target hms @var{dev}
11863A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11864commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11865the communications speed used.
11866
d4f3574e 11867@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
104c1213
JM
11868@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11869E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
11870
d4f3574e
SS
11871@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11872@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
104c1213
JM
11873@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11874@item target sh3e @var{dev}
11875Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11876
11877@end table
11878
6d2ebf8b 11879@node Sparclet
104c1213
JM
11880@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
11881
11882@cindex Sparclet
11883
5d161b24
DB
11884@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11885Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
104c1213
JM
11886@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11887both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
5d161b24 11888@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213
JM
11889
11890@table @code
f0ca3dce 11891@item remotetimeout @var{args}
104c1213 11892@kindex remotetimeout
5d161b24
DB
11893@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11894This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11895seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
11896@end table
11897
41afff9a 11898@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
5d161b24 11899When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
d4f3574e 11900information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
5d161b24 11901load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
d4f3574e 11902@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213
JM
11903
11904@example
11905sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11906@end example
11907
d4f3574e 11908You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213
JM
11909
11910@example
11911sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11912@end example
11913
41afff9a 11914@cindex running, on Sparclet
104c1213
JM
11915Once you have set
11916your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
5d161b24 11917run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
104c1213
JM
11918(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
11919
11920@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11921
11922@example
11923(gdbslet)
11924@end example
11925
11926@menu
11927* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11928* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11929* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
5d161b24 11930* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
11931@end menu
11932
6d2ebf8b 11933@node Sparclet File
104c1213
JM
11934@subsubsection Setting file to debug
11935
11936The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
11937
11938@example
11939(gdbslet) file prog
11940@end example
11941
11942@need 1000
11943@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11944@value{GDBN} locates
11945the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11946path.
11947If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11948files will be searched as well.
11949@value{GDBN} locates
11950the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11951path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11952If it fails
11953to find a file, it displays a message such as:
11954
11955@example
11956prog: No such file or directory.
11957@end example
11958
11959When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
5d161b24 11960the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
104c1213
JM
11961@code{target} command again.
11962
6d2ebf8b 11963@node Sparclet Connection
104c1213
JM
11964@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
11965
11966The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11967To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
11968
11969@example
11970(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11971Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
5d161b24 11972main () at ../prog.c:3
104c1213
JM
11973@end example
11974
11975@need 750
11976@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11977
d4f3574e 11978@example
104c1213 11979Connected to ttya.
d4f3574e 11980@end example
104c1213 11981
6d2ebf8b 11982@node Sparclet Download
104c1213
JM
11983@subsubsection Sparclet download
11984
11985@cindex download to Sparclet
5d161b24 11986Once connected to the Sparclet target,
104c1213
JM
11987you can use the @value{GDBN}
11988@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11989The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11990command.
5d161b24 11991Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
d4f3574e 11992address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
104c1213
JM
11993offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11994of each of the file's sections.
11995For instance, if the program
11996@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
11997and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11998
11999@example
12000(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12001Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
12002@end example
12003
5d161b24
DB
12004If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12005to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
104c1213
JM
12006to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12007
6d2ebf8b 12008@node Sparclet Execution
104c1213
JM
12009@subsubsection Running and debugging
12010
12011@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12012You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
5d161b24 12013commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
104c1213
JM
12014manual for the list of commands.
12015
12016@example
12017(gdbslet) b main
12018Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
5d161b24 12019(gdbslet) run
104c1213
JM
12020Starting program: prog
12021Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
120223 char *symarg = 0;
12023(gdbslet) step
120244 char *execarg = "hello!";
5d161b24 12025(gdbslet)
104c1213
JM
12026@end example
12027
6d2ebf8b 12028@node Sparclite
104c1213
JM
12029@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
12030
12031@table @code
12032
12033@kindex target sparclite
12034@item target sparclite @var{dev}
5d161b24
DB
12035Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12036You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12037For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
104c1213
JM
12038remote protocol.
12039
12040@end table
12041
6d2ebf8b 12042@node ST2000
104c1213
JM
12043@subsection Tandem ST2000
12044
2df3850c 12045@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
104c1213
JM
12046STDBUG protocol.
12047
12048To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12049manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
12050
12051@example
12052target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
12053@end example
12054
12055@noindent
12056to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12057the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12058ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12059connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12060concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12061
12062The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12063this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12064would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12065(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12066available on your host computer.
12067@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12068@c basically hearsay.
12069
12070@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12071These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12072environment:
12073
12074@table @code
12075@item st2000 @var{command}
12076@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12077@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12078@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12079Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12080manual for available commands.
12081
12082@item connect
12083@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12084Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12085you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12086sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12087@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12088@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12089@end table
12090
6d2ebf8b 12091@node Z8000
104c1213
JM
12092@subsection Zilog Z8000
12093
12094@cindex Z8000
12095@cindex simulator, Z8000
12096@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12097
12098When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12099a Z8000 simulator.
12100
12101For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12102unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12103segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12104appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12105
12106@table @code
12107@item target sim @var{args}
12108@kindex sim
d4f3574e 12109@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
104c1213
JM
12110Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12111options, specify them via @var{args}.
12112@end table
12113
12114@noindent
12115After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12116CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12117@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12118to run your program, and so on.
12119
d4f3574e
SS
12120As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12121(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12122additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
12123
12124@table @code
12125
12126@item cycles
12127Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12128
12129@item insts
12130Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12131
12132@item time
12133Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12134
12135@end table
12136
12137You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12138conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12139conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12140simulated clock ticks.
12141
6d2ebf8b 12142@node Architectures
104c1213
JM
12143@section Architectures
12144
12145This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
2df3850c 12146all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213
JM
12147
12148@menu
12149* A29K::
12150* Alpha::
12151* MIPS::
12152@end menu
12153
6d2ebf8b 12154@node A29K
104c1213
JM
12155@subsection A29K
12156
12157@table @code
12158
12159@kindex set rstack_high_address
12160@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12161@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12162@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12163On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
d4f3574e 12164@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
104c1213
JM
12165extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12166stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12167memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12168this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12169the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12170address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12171hexadecimal.
12172
12173@kindex show rstack_high_address
12174@item show rstack_high_address
12175Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12176processors.
12177
12178@end table
12179
6d2ebf8b 12180@node Alpha
104c1213
JM
12181@subsection Alpha
12182
12183See the following section.
12184
6d2ebf8b 12185@node MIPS
104c1213
JM
12186@subsection MIPS
12187
12188@cindex stack on Alpha
12189@cindex stack on MIPS
12190@cindex Alpha stack
12191@cindex MIPS stack
12192Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12193sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12194find the beginning of a function.
12195
12196@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12197To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12198@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12199you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12200commands:
12201
12202@table @code
00e4a2e4 12203@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
104c1213
JM
12204@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12205Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12206search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12207default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12208larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12209and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12210
12211@item show heuristic-fence-post
12212Display the current limit.
12213@end table
12214
12215@noindent
12216These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12217for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12218
12219
6d2ebf8b 12220@node Controlling GDB
c906108c
SS
12221@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12222
53a5351d
JM
12223You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12224@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
d4f3574e 12225data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
53a5351d 12226described here.
c906108c
SS
12227
12228@menu
12229* Prompt:: Prompt
12230* Editing:: Command editing
12231* History:: Command history
12232* Screen Size:: Screen size
12233* Numbers:: Numbers
12234* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
5d161b24 12235* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
c906108c
SS
12236@end menu
12237
6d2ebf8b 12238@node Prompt
c906108c
SS
12239@section Prompt
12240
12241@cindex prompt
12242
12243@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12244called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12245can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12246instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
5d161b24 12247the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
c906108c
SS
12248which one you are talking to.
12249
d4f3574e 12250@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
c906108c
SS
12251prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12252or a prompt that does not.
12253
12254@table @code
12255@kindex set prompt
12256@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12257Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12258
12259@kindex show prompt
12260@item show prompt
12261Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12262@end table
12263
6d2ebf8b 12264@node Editing
c906108c
SS
12265@section Command editing
12266@cindex readline
12267@cindex command line editing
12268
12269@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12270@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12271command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12272or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12273substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12274debugging sessions.
12275
12276You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12277command @code{set}.
12278
12279@table @code
12280@kindex set editing
12281@cindex editing
12282@item set editing
12283@itemx set editing on
12284Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12285
12286@item set editing off
12287Disable command line editing.
12288
12289@kindex show editing
12290@item show editing
12291Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12292@end table
12293
6d2ebf8b 12294@node History
c906108c
SS
12295@section Command history
12296
12297@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12298debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12299happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12300history facility.
12301
12302@table @code
12303@cindex history substitution
12304@cindex history file
12305@kindex set history filename
12306@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12307@item set history filename @var{fname}
12308Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12309This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12310list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12311exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12312the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12313to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
d4f3574e
SS
12314@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12315is not set.
c906108c
SS
12316
12317@cindex history save
12318@kindex set history save
12319@item set history save
12320@itemx set history save on
12321Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12322@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12323
12324@item set history save off
12325Stop recording command history in a file.
12326
12327@cindex history size
12328@kindex set history size
12329@item set history size @var{size}
12330Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12331This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12332@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12333@end table
12334
12335@cindex history expansion
12336History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12337@ifset have-readline-appendices
12338@xref{Event Designators}.
12339@end ifset
12340
12341Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12342is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12343@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12344follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12345a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12346history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12347@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12348
12349The commands to control history expansion are:
12350
12351@table @code
12352@kindex set history expansion
12353@item set history expansion on
12354@itemx set history expansion
12355Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
12356
12357@item set history expansion off
12358Disable history expansion.
12359
12360The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12361editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12362or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12363@ifset have-readline-appendices
12364@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12365@end ifset
12366
12367@c @group
12368@kindex show history
12369@item show history
12370@itemx show history filename
12371@itemx show history save
12372@itemx show history size
12373@itemx show history expansion
12374These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12375@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12376@c @end group
12377@end table
12378
12379@table @code
41afff9a 12380@kindex shows
c906108c
SS
12381@item show commands
12382Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12383
12384@item show commands @var{n}
12385Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12386
12387@item show commands +
12388Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12389@end table
12390
6d2ebf8b 12391@node Screen Size
c906108c
SS
12392@section Screen size
12393@cindex size of screen
12394@cindex pauses in output
12395
12396Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12397information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12398@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12399output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12400to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12401determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12402printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12403rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12404
d4f3574e
SS
12405Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12406driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
c906108c 12407together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
d4f3574e 12408@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
c906108c
SS
12409you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12410width} commands:
12411
12412@table @code
12413@kindex set height
12414@kindex set width
12415@kindex show width
12416@kindex show height
12417@item set height @var{lpp}
12418@itemx show height
12419@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12420@itemx show width
12421These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12422a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12423commands display the current settings.
12424
5d161b24
DB
12425If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12426output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
c906108c
SS
12427file or to an editor buffer.
12428
12429Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12430from wrapping its output.
12431@end table
12432
6d2ebf8b 12433@node Numbers
c906108c
SS
12434@section Numbers
12435@cindex number representation
12436@cindex entering numbers
12437
2df3850c
JM
12438You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12439@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12440@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12441begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12442default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12443numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12444change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12445radix} command.
c906108c
SS
12446
12447@table @code
12448@kindex set input-radix
12449@item set input-radix @var{base}
12450Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12451for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12452specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12453example, any of
12454
12455@smallexample
12456set radix 012
12457set radix 10.
12458set radix 0xa
12459@end smallexample
12460
12461@noindent
12462sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12463leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
12464
12465@kindex set output-radix
12466@item set output-radix @var{base}
12467Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12468for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12469specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
12470
12471@kindex show input-radix
12472@item show input-radix
12473Display the current default base for numeric input.
12474
12475@kindex show output-radix
12476@item show output-radix
12477Display the current default base for numeric display.
12478@end table
12479
6d2ebf8b 12480@node Messages/Warnings
c906108c
SS
12481@section Optional warnings and messages
12482
2df3850c
JM
12483By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12484running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12485command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12486internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
c906108c
SS
12487
12488Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12489which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12490see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
12491
12492@table @code
12493@kindex set verbose
12494@item set verbose on
12495Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12496
12497@item set verbose off
12498Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12499
12500@kindex show verbose
12501@item show verbose
12502Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12503@end table
12504
2df3850c
JM
12505By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12506object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12507find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12508symbol files}).
c906108c
SS
12509
12510@table @code
2df3850c 12511
c906108c
SS
12512@kindex set complaints
12513@item set complaints @var{limit}
2df3850c
JM
12514Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12515unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12516@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12517to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
c906108c
SS
12518
12519@kindex show complaints
12520@item show complaints
12521Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
2df3850c 12522
c906108c
SS
12523@end table
12524
12525By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12526lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12527you try to run a program which is already running:
12528
12529@example
12530(@value{GDBP}) run
12531The program being debugged has been started already.
12532Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
12533@end example
12534
12535If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12536commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
12537
12538@table @code
2df3850c 12539
c906108c
SS
12540@kindex set confirm
12541@cindex flinching
12542@cindex confirmation
12543@cindex stupid questions
12544@item set confirm off
12545Disables confirmation requests.
12546
12547@item set confirm on
12548Enables confirmation requests (the default).
12549
12550@kindex show confirm
12551@item show confirm
12552Displays state of confirmation requests.
2df3850c 12553
c906108c
SS
12554@end table
12555
6d2ebf8b 12556@node Debugging Output
5d161b24
DB
12557@section Optional messages about internal happenings
12558@table @code
12559@kindex set debug arch
12560@item set debug arch
12561Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12562@kindex show debug arch
12563@item show debug arch
12564Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12565@kindex set debug event
12566@item set debug event
12567Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12568default is off.
12569@kindex show debug event
12570@item show debug event
12571Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12572info.
12573@kindex set debug expression
12574@item set debug expression
12575Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12576default is off.
12577@kindex show debug expression
12578@item show debug expression
12579Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12580debugging info.
12581@kindex set debug overload
12582@item set debug overload
b37052ae 12583Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
5d161b24
DB
12584info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12585is off.
12586@kindex show debug overload
12587@item show debug overload
b37052ae 12588Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
5d161b24
DB
12589debugging info.
12590@kindex set debug remote
12591@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12592@cindex serial connections, debugging
12593@item set debug remote
12594Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12595the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12596@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12597@kindex show debug remote
12598@item show debug remote
12599Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12600@kindex set debug serial
12601@item set debug serial
12602Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12603default is off.
12604@kindex show debug serial
12605@item show debug serial
12606Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12607info.
12608@kindex set debug target
12609@item set debug target
12610Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12611includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12612default is off.
12613@kindex show debug target
12614@item show debug target
12615Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12616info.
12617@kindex set debug varobj
12618@item set debug varobj
12619Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12620info. The default is off.
12621@kindex show debug varobj
12622@item show debug varobj
12623Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12624debugging info.
12625@end table
12626
6d2ebf8b 12627@node Sequences
c906108c
SS
12628@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
12629
12630Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
2df3850c
JM
12631command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12632commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12633files.
c906108c
SS
12634
12635@menu
12636* Define:: User-defined commands
12637* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12638* Command Files:: Command files
12639* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12640@end menu
12641
6d2ebf8b 12642@node Define
c906108c
SS
12643@section User-defined commands
12644
12645@cindex user-defined command
2df3850c
JM
12646A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12647which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12648@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12649separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12650via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
c906108c
SS
12651
12652@smallexample
12653define adder
12654 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12655@end smallexample
12656
d4f3574e
SS
12657@noindent
12658To execute the command use:
c906108c
SS
12659
12660@smallexample
12661adder 1 2 3
12662@end smallexample
12663
d4f3574e
SS
12664@noindent
12665This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
5d161b24 12666its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
c906108c
SS
12667reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12668functions calls.
12669
12670@table @code
2df3850c 12671
c906108c
SS
12672@kindex define
12673@item define @var{commandname}
12674Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12675by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
12676
12677The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12678which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12679commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12680
12681@kindex if
12682@kindex else
12683@item if
12684Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12685It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12686only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12687There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12688by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12689was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
12690
12691@kindex while
12692@item while
12693The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12694which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12695execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12696The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12697evaluates to true.
12698
12699@kindex document
12700@item document @var{commandname}
12701Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
5d161b24
DB
12702accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12703defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12704reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12705After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
c906108c
SS
12706@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
12707
12708You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12709documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12710does not change the documentation.
12711
12712@kindex help user-defined
12713@item help user-defined
12714List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12715(if any) for each.
12716
12717@kindex show user
12718@item show user
12719@itemx show user @var{commandname}
2df3850c
JM
12720Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12721not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
c906108c 12722definitions for all user-defined commands.
2df3850c 12723
c906108c
SS
12724@end table
12725
12726When user-defined commands are executed, the
12727commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12728stops execution of the user-defined command.
12729
12730If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
5d161b24
DB
12731without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12732commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
c906108c
SS
12733messages when used in a user-defined command.
12734
6d2ebf8b 12735@node Hooks
c906108c 12736@section User-defined command hooks
d4f3574e
SS
12737@cindex command hooks
12738@cindex hooks, for commands
c78b4128 12739@cindex hooks, pre-command
c906108c 12740
c78b4128
EZ
12741@kindex hook
12742@kindex hook-
12743You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
c906108c
SS
12744command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12745command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12746before that command.
12747
c78b4128
EZ
12748@cindex hooks, post-command
12749@kindex hookpost
12750@kindex hookpost-
12751A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12752Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12753@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12754that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12755pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
12756
12757It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12758occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
12759
12760@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12761@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
12762
d4f3574e 12763@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
c906108c
SS
12764In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12765(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12766execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12767displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
12768
c906108c
SS
12769For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12770single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12771you could define:
12772
12773@example
12774define hook-stop
12775handle SIGALRM nopass
12776end
12777
12778define hook-run
12779handle SIGALRM pass
12780end
12781
12782define hook-continue
12783handle SIGLARM pass
12784end
12785@end example
c906108c 12786
c78b4128
EZ
12787As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12788command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12789you could define:
12790
12791@example
12792define hook-echo
12793echo <<<---
12794end
12795
12796define hookpost-echo
12797echo --->>>\n
12798end
12799
12800(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12801<<<---Hello World--->>>
12802(@value{GDBP})
12803
12804@end example
12805
c906108c
SS
12806You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12807not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12808name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12809@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12810@c or not?
12811If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12812@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12813(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
12814
12815If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12816get a warning from the @code{define} command.
12817
6d2ebf8b 12818@node Command Files
c906108c
SS
12819@section Command files
12820
12821@cindex command files
5d161b24
DB
12822A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12823commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12824An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
c906108c
SS
12825the last command, as it would from the terminal.
12826
12827@cindex init file
12828@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
d4f3574e 12829@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
c906108c 12830When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
bf0184be
ND
12831@dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix and
12832@file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. During startup, @value{GDBN} does the
12833following:
12834
12835@enumerate
12836@item
12837Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12838DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12839@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
12840
12841@item
12842Processes command line options and operands.
12843
12844@item
12845Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
12846
12847@item
12848Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12849@end enumerate
12850
12851The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12852complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12853and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12854option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 12855
c906108c
SS
12856@cindex init file name
12857On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12858different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12859form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12860different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12861environments with special init file names:
12862
00e4a2e4 12863@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c
SS
12864@itemize @bullet
12865@item
00e4a2e4 12866VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 12867
00e4a2e4 12868@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12869@item
00e4a2e4 12870OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12871
00e4a2e4 12872@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 12873@item
00e4a2e4 12874ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
c906108c 12875@end itemize
c906108c
SS
12876
12877You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12878@code{source} command:
12879
12880@table @code
12881@kindex source
12882@item source @var{filename}
12883Execute the command file @var{filename}.
12884@end table
12885
12886The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
12887printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
12888of the command file.
12889
12890Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12891without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12892normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12893when called from command files.
12894
6d2ebf8b 12895@node Output
c906108c
SS
12896@section Commands for controlled output
12897
12898During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
12899@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
12900explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
12901describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
12902want.
12903
12904@table @code
12905@kindex echo
12906@item echo @var{text}
12907@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
12908@c because it is not in ANSI.
12909Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
12910@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
12911newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
12912In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
12913by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
12914string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
5d161b24 12915trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
c906108c
SS
12916To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12917@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
12918
12919A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
12920the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
12921
12922@example
12923echo This is some text\n\
12924which is continued\n\
12925onto several lines.\n
12926@end example
12927
12928produces the same output as
12929
12930@example
12931echo This is some text\n
12932echo which is continued\n
12933echo onto several lines.\n
12934@end example
12935
12936@kindex output
12937@item output @var{expression}
12938Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
12939newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
5d161b24 12940value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
c906108c
SS
12941on expressions.
12942
12943@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
12944Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
12945the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
12946formats}, for more information.
12947
12948@kindex printf
12949@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
12950Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
12951@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
12952either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
12953@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
12954subroutine
d4f3574e
SS
12955@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
12956@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
12957@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
12958@c supported.
c906108c
SS
12959
12960@example
12961printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
12962@end example
12963
12964For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
12965
12966@smallexample
12967printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
12968@end smallexample
12969
12970The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
12971string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
12972letter.
12973@end table
12974
6d2ebf8b 12975@node Emacs
c906108c
SS
12976@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
12977
12978@cindex Emacs
12979@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
12980A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
12981edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
12982@value{GDBN}.
12983
12984To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
12985executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
12986@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
12987created Emacs buffer.
53a5351d 12988@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c
SS
12989
12990Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
12991things:
12992
12993@itemize @bullet
12994@item
12995All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
12996@end itemize
12997
12998This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
12999and output done by the program you are debugging.
13000
13001This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13002commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13003in this way.
13004
13005All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13006with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13007way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13008stop.
13009
13010@itemize @bullet
13011@item
13012@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13013@end itemize
13014
13015Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13016source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13017left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13018source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13019and the source.
13020
13021Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13022usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
13023
13024@quotation
13025@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13026current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13027the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13028appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13029environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13030session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13031back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13032avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13033your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13034@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
13035
13036A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13037switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13038@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13039@end quotation
13040
13041By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13042you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13043several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13044Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13045
13046@example
13047(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
13048@end example
13049
13050@noindent
d4f3574e 13051(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
c906108c
SS
13052in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13053``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13054
13055In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13056addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
13057
13058@table @kbd
13059@item C-h m
13060Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
13061
13062@item M-s
13063Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13064update the display window to show the current file and location.
13065
13066@item M-n
13067Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13068calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13069to show the current file and location.
13070
13071@item M-i
13072Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13073display window accordingly.
13074
13075@item M-x gdb-nexti
13076Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13077display window accordingly.
13078
13079@item C-c C-f
13080Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13081@code{finish} command.
13082
13083@item M-c
13084Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13085command.
13086
13087@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
13088
13089@item M-u
13090Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13091(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13092like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
13093
13094@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
13095
13096@item M-d
13097Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13098@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
13099
13100@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
13101
13102@item C-x &
13103Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13104of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13105around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13106then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13107argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
13108
13109You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13110@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13111otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13112inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13113wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13114list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13115formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13116is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13117@end table
13118
13119In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13120tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
13121
13122If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13123it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13124request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13125the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13126frame.
13127
13128The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13129which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13130the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13131communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13132delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13133to correspond properly with the code.
13134
13135@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13136@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13137@ignore
13138@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13139@kindex Epoch
13140@kindex inspect
13141
5d161b24 13142Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
c906108c
SS
13143called the @code{epoch}
13144environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13145@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13146each value is printed in its own window.
13147@end ignore
c906108c 13148
d700128c 13149@include annotate.texi
7162c0ca 13150@include gdbmi.texinfo
d700128c 13151
6d2ebf8b 13152@node GDB Bugs
c906108c
SS
13153@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13154@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13155@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
13156
13157Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
13158
13159Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13160may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13161the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13162reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
13163
13164In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13165information that enables us to fix the bug.
13166
13167@menu
13168* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13169* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
13170@end menu
13171
6d2ebf8b 13172@node Bug Criteria
c906108c
SS
13173@section Have you found a bug?
13174@cindex bug criteria
13175
13176If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
13177
13178@itemize @bullet
13179@cindex fatal signal
13180@cindex debugger crash
13181@cindex crash of debugger
13182@item
13183If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13184@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13185
13186@cindex error on valid input
13187@item
13188If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13189bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13190somewhere in the connection to the target.)
13191
13192@cindex invalid input
13193@item
13194If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13195that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13196``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13197for traditional practice''.
13198
13199@item
13200If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13201for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
13202@end itemize
13203
6d2ebf8b 13204@node Bug Reporting
c906108c
SS
13205@section How to report bugs
13206@cindex bug reports
13207@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13208
c906108c
SS
13209A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13210If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13211contact that organization first.
13212
13213You can find contact information for many support companies and
13214individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13215distribution.
13216@c should add a web page ref...
13217
13218In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
13219@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
13220
13221@example
d4f3574e 13222bug-gdb@@gnu.org
c906108c
SS
13223@end example
13224
13225@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
d4f3574e 13226@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
c906108c
SS
13227not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13228@samp{bug-gdb}.
13229
13230The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13231serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13232the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13233newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13234problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13235path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13236we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13237bug reports to the mailing list.
13238
13239As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
13240
13241@example
13242@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
13243Free Software Foundation Inc.
1324459 Temple Place - Suite 330
13245Boston, MA 02111-1307
13246USA
13247@end example
c906108c
SS
13248
13249The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13250@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13251fact or leave it out, state it!
13252
13253Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13254problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13255assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13256Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13257stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13258name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13259of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13260the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13261easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
13262
13263Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13264bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13265you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13266self-contained.
13267
13268Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13269bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13270@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13271bugs properly.
13272
13273To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
13274
13275@itemize @bullet
13276@item
13277The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13278with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13279version}.
13280
13281Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13282the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
13283
13284@item
13285The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13286version number.
13287
c906108c
SS
13288@item
13289What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13290``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c906108c
SS
13291
13292@item
13293What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13294debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13295C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13296information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13297compilers.
13298
13299@item
13300The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13301observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13302you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13303Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
13304
13305If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13306and then we might not encounter the bug.
13307
13308@item
13309A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13310reproduce the bug.
13311
13312@item
13313A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13314incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
13315
13316Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13317will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13318not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13319a chance to make a mistake.
13320
13321Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13322say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13323copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13324the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13325crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13326ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13327us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13328to draw any conclusion from our observations.
13329
c906108c
SS
13330@item
13331If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13332diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13333it by context, not by line number.
13334
13335The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13336sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
53a5351d 13337
c906108c
SS
13338@end itemize
13339
13340Here are some things that are not necessary:
13341
13342@itemize @bullet
13343@item
13344A description of the envelope of the bug.
13345
13346Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13347which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13348changes will not affect it.
13349
13350This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13351will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13352with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13353We recommend that you save your time for something else.
13354
13355Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13356of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13357output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13358less time, and so on.
13359
13360However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13361report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
13362
13363@item
13364A patch for the bug.
13365
13366A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13367the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13368a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13369to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
13370
13371Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13372construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13373through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13374to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
13375
13376And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13377patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13378help us to understand.
13379
13380@item
13381A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
13382
13383Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13384things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13385@end itemize
13386
5d161b24 13387@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
c906108c
SS
13388@c and consists of the two following files:
13389@c rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 13390@c inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
13391@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13392@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13393@include rluser.texinfo
7be570e7 13394@include inc-hist.texinfo
c906108c
SS
13395
13396
6d2ebf8b 13397@node Formatting Documentation
c906108c
SS
13398@appendix Formatting Documentation
13399
13400@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13401@cindex reference card
13402The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13403for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13404subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13405@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13406release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13407you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
13408
13409The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13410can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
13411
13412@example
13413make refcard.dvi
13414@end example
13415
5d161b24
DB
13416The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13417mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
c906108c
SS
13418that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13419high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13420your @sc{dvi} output program.
13421
13422@cindex documentation
13423
13424All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13425distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13426a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13427on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13428formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13429and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
13430
13431@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13432version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13433file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13434subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13435necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13436but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13437Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13438@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
13439
13440If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13441Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13442@code{makeinfo}.
13443
13444If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13445@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13446version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
13447
13448@example
13449cd gdb
13450make gdb.info
13451@end example
13452
13453If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13454a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13455Texinfo definitions file.
13456
13457@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13458produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13459document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13460has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13461command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13462(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
13463require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
13464
13465@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13466@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13467written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13468typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
13469and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
13470directory.
13471
13472If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
13473typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
13474subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
13475@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
13476
13477@example
13478make gdb.dvi
13479@end example
13480
13481Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c906108c 13482
6d2ebf8b 13483@node Installing GDB
c906108c
SS
13484@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
13485@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
13486@cindex installation
13487
c906108c
SS
13488@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
13489of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
13490build the @code{gdb} program.
13491@iftex
13492@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
13493@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
13494look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
13495installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
13496@end iftex
13497
5d161b24
DB
13498The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
13499@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
c906108c
SS
13500appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
13501
13502For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
13503@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
13504
13505@table @code
13506@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
13507script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
13508
13509@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
13510the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
13511
13512@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13513source for the Binary File Descriptor library
13514
13515@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
13516@sc{gnu} include files
13517
13518@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
13519source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
13520
13521@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
13522source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
13523
13524@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
13525source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
13526
13527@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
13528source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
13529
13530@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
13531source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
13532@end table
13533
13534The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
13535from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
13536this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
13537
13538First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
13539if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
13540identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
13541argument.
13542
13543For example:
13544
13545@example
13546cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13547./configure @var{host}
13548make
13549@end example
13550
13551@noindent
13552where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
13553@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
13554(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
13555correct value by examining your system.)
13556
13557Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
13558@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
13559libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
13560binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
13561
13562@need 750
13563@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
13564system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
13565shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
13566
13567@example
13568sh configure @var{host}
13569@end example
13570
13571If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
13572directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
13573@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
13574creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
13575you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
13576
13577You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
13578subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
13579configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
13580
13581For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
13582the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
13583
13584@example
13585@group
13586cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13587../configure @var{host}
13588@end group
13589@end example
13590
13591You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
13592However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
13593the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
13594that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
13595let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
13596
13597@menu
13598* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13599* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
13600* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
13601@end menu
13602
6d2ebf8b 13603@node Separate Objdir
c906108c
SS
13604@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13605
13606If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
13607you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
13608host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
13609allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
13610rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
13611handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
13612@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
13613program specified there.
13614
13615To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
13616with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
13617(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
13618itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
13619would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
13620the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
13621
5d161b24 13622For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
c906108c
SS
13623separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
13624
13625@example
13626@group
13627cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13628mkdir ../gdb-sun4
13629cd ../gdb-sun4
13630../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
13631make
13632@end group
13633@end example
13634
13635When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
13636directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
13637(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
13638the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
13639directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
13640@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
13641
13642One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
5d161b24
DB
13643directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
13644@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
13645programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
c906108c
SS
13646You specify a cross-debugging target by
13647giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
13648
13649When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
13650it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
13651called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
13652
13653The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
13654directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
13655directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
13656directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
13657will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
13658
13659When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
13660directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
13661if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
13662with each other.
13663
6d2ebf8b 13664@node Config Names
c906108c
SS
13665@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
13666
13667The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
13668script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
13669aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
13670of information in the following pattern:
13671
13672@example
13673@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
13674@end example
13675
13676For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
13677or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
13678option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
13679
13680The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
13681any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
13682aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
13683@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
13684script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
13685abbreviations---for example:
13686
13687@smallexample
13688% sh config.sub i386-linux
13689i386-pc-linux-gnu
13690% sh config.sub alpha-linux
13691alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
13692% sh config.sub hp9k700
13693hppa1.1-hp-hpux
13694% sh config.sub sun4
13695sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
13696% sh config.sub sun3
13697m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
13698% sh config.sub i986v
13699Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
13700@end smallexample
13701
13702@noindent
13703@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
13704directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
13705
6d2ebf8b 13706@node Configure Options
c906108c
SS
13707@section @code{configure} options
13708
13709Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
13710are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
13711several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
13712Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
13713
13714@example
13715configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
13716 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13717 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13718 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
13719 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
13720 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
13721 @var{host}
13722@end example
13723
13724@noindent
13725You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
13726@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
13727@samp{--}.
13728
13729@table @code
13730@item --help
13731Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
13732
13733@item --prefix=@var{dir}
13734Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
13735@file{@var{dir}}.
13736
13737@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
13738Configure the source to install programs under directory
13739@file{@var{dir}}.
13740
13741@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
13742@need 2000
13743@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
13744@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
13745@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
13746Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
13747@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
13748build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
13749directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
13750the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
13751directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
13752the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
13753@var{dirname}.
13754
13755@item --norecursion
13756Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
13757propagate configuration to subdirectories.
13758
13759@item --target=@var{target}
13760Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
13761@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
13762programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
13763
13764There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
13765
13766@item @var{host} @dots{}
13767Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
13768
13769There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
13770@end table
13771
13772There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
13773needed for special purposes only.
5d161b24 13774
6d2ebf8b 13775@node Index
c906108c
SS
13776@unnumbered Index
13777
13778@printindex cp
13779
13780@tex
13781% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
13782% meantime:
13783\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
13784\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
13785\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
13786\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
13787\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
13788\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
13789\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
13790\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
13791\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
13792\page\colophon
13793% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
13794@end tex
13795
449f3b6c
AC
13796@c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
13797@ifinfo
c906108c 13798@contents
449f3b6c
AC
13799@end ifinfo
13800@ifhtml
13801@contents
13802@end ifhtml
13803
c906108c 13804@bye
This page took 0.744112 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.